Add ability to change linker warning messages into errors when reporting executable...
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-linker-version
465 @item --enable-linker-version
466 Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467 in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468 script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469 linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471 Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472 significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473 the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475 @kindex --disable-linker-version
476 @item --disable-linker-version
477 Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478 does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
480 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490 @smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509 @end smallexample
510
511 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516 This option enables warnings when
517 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520 output region.
521
522 @cindex entry point, from command line
523 @kindex -e @var{entry}
524 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
525 @item -e @var{entry}
526 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
535 @kindex --exclude-libs
536 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
538 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
539 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544 be treated as hidden.
545
546 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557 regardless of this option.
558
559 @cindex dynamic symbol table
560 @kindex -E
561 @kindex --export-dynamic
562 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
563 @item -E
564 @itemx --export-dynamic
565 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
566 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
575
576 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579 linking the program itself.
580
581 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
582 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
583 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
584
585 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
589 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590 @cindex export dynamic symbol
591 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
602 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
607 @ifclear SingleFormat
608 @cindex big-endian objects
609 @cindex endianness
610 @kindex -EB
611 @item -EB
612 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614 @cindex little-endian objects
615 @kindex -EL
616 @item -EL
617 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
618 @end ifclear
619
620 @kindex -f @var{name}
621 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622 @item -f @var{name}
623 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
624 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
637 machine-specific performance.
638
639 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
642 @kindex -F @var{name}
643 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
644 @item -F @var{name}
645 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
646 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657 @var{name}.
658
659 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
660 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
661 object files.
662 @ifclear SingleFormat
663 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
664 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
665 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
666 environment variable.
667 @end ifclear
668 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669 creating an ELF shared object.
670
671 @cindex finalization function
672 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
673 @item -fini=@var{name}
674 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677 the function to call.
678
679 @kindex -g
680 @item -g
681 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
683 @kindex -G @var{value}
684 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
685 @cindex object size
686 @item -G @var{value}
687 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
690 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
691 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693 @cindex runtime library name
694 @kindex -h @var{name}
695 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
696 @item -h @var{name}
697 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
698 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
702 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
703
704 @kindex -i
705 @cindex incremental link
706 @item -i
707 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
709 @cindex initialization function
710 @kindex -init=@var{name}
711 @item -init=@var{name}
712 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715 function to call.
716
717 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
718 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
719 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
720 @item -l @var{namespec}
721 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
725 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
726 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
727
728 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
729 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735 @var{filename}.
736
737 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
744 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
745 archives multiple times.
746
747 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749 @ifset GENERIC
750 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
751 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
752 behaviour of the AIX linker.
753 @end ifset
754
755 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
756 @kindex -L @var{dir}
757 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
758 @item -L @var{searchdir}
759 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
760 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
762 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
765 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
766 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768 option is specified.
769
770 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
773
774 @ifset UsesEnvVars
775 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
776 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
777 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778 @end ifset
779
780 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784 @cindex emulation
785 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
786 @item -m @var{emulation}
787 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794 configured.
795
796 @cindex remapping inputs
797 @kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798 @kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799 @item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800 @itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801 These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802 linker attempts to open them. The option
803 @option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804 file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805 @file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806 so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807 matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809 An alternative form of the option
810 @option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811 from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812 Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813 the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814 The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815 or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817 The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818 accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819 they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820 order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821 checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823 If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824 then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825 This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826 from a complicated build environment.
827
828 Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829 that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831 @smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833 @end smallexample
834
835 Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837 @smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839 @end smallexample
840
841 Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843 Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844 statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845 after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846 options on the command line is not significant.
847
848 If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849 will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850 be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851 appear.
852
853 If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854 the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
856 @cindex link map
857 @kindex -M
858 @kindex --print-map
859 @item -M
860 @itemx --print-map
861 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862 information about the link, including the following:
863
864 @itemize @bullet
865 @item
866 Where object files are mapped into memory.
867 @item
868 How common symbols are allocated.
869 @item
870 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
872 @item
873 The values assigned to symbols.
874
875 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881 linker script containing:
882
883 @smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887 @end smallexample
888
889 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890 option is used:
891
892 @smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896 @end smallexample
897
898 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899 scripts.
900
901 @item
902 How GNU properties are merged.
903
904 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
907
908 @smallexample
909 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910 @end smallexample
911
912 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
913 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916 @smallexample
917 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
918 @end smallexample
919
920 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
921 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
923
924 @item
925 On some ELF targets, a list of fixups inserted by @option{--relax}
926
927 @smallexample
928 foo.o: Adjusting branch at 0x00000008 towards "far" in section .text
929 @end smallexample
930
931 This indicates that the branch at 0x00000008 in foo.o, targeting
932 the symbol "far" in section .text, has been replaced by a trampoline.
933
934 @end itemize
935
936 @cindex link map discarded
937 @kindex --print-map-discarded
938 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
939 @item --print-map-discarded
940 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
941 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
942 in the link map. Enabled by default.
943
944 @kindex --print-map-locals
945 @kindex --no-print-map-locals
946 @item --print-map-locals
947 @itemx --no-print-map-locals
948 Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
949 will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
950 be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
951 Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
952 will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
953
954 @kindex -n
955 @cindex read-only text
956 @cindex NMAGIC
957 @kindex --nmagic
958 @item -n
959 @itemx --nmagic
960 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
961 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
962 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
963
964 @kindex -N
965 @kindex --omagic
966 @cindex read/write from cmd line
967 @cindex OMAGIC
968 @item -N
969 @itemx --omagic
970 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
971 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
972 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
973 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
974 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
975 specification published by Microsoft.
976
977 @kindex --no-omagic
978 @cindex OMAGIC
979 @item --no-omagic
980 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
981 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
982 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
983 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
984
985 @kindex -o @var{output}
986 @kindex --output=@var{output}
987 @cindex naming the output file
988 @item -o @var{output}
989 @itemx --output=@var{output}
990 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
991 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
992 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
993
994 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
995 @cindex dependency file
996 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
997 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
998 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
999 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
1000 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
1001 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
1002 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
1003 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
1004 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
1005 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
1006 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
1007 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
1008
1009 @kindex -O @var{level}
1010 @cindex generating optimized output
1011 @item -O @var{level}
1012 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
1013 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
1014 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1015 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1016 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1017 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1018 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
1019
1020 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
1021 @item -plugin @var{name}
1022 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1023 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1024 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1025 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1026 wish.
1027
1028 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1029 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1030 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1031 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
1032 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
1033 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
1034 just copy in the newest one.
1035
1036 @kindex --push-state
1037 @cindex push state governing input file handling
1038 @item --push-state
1039 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
1040 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1041 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1042
1043 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1044 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1045 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1046 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1047 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1048 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1049
1050 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1051 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1052 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1053 something as follows:
1054
1055 @smallexample
1056 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1057 @end smallexample
1058
1059 @kindex --pop-state
1060 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
1061 @item --pop-state
1062 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1063 flags governing input file handling.
1064
1065 @kindex -q
1066 @kindex --emit-relocs
1067 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
1068 @item -q
1069 @itemx --emit-relocs
1070 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
1071 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1072 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1073 in larger executables.
1074
1075 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1076
1077 @kindex --force-dynamic
1078 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1079 @item --force-dynamic
1080 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1081 to VxWorks targets.
1082
1083 @cindex partial link
1084 @cindex relocatable output
1085 @kindex -r
1086 @kindex --relocatable
1087 @item -r
1088 @itemx --relocatable
1089 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
1090 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
1091 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1092 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1093 @code{OMAGIC}.
1094 @c ; see @option{-N}.
1095 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1096 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1097 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1098
1099 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1100 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1101 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1102 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1103 with input files in other formats at all.
1104
1105 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1106
1107 @kindex -R @var{file}
1108 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1109 @cindex symbol-only input
1110 @item -R @var{filename}
1111 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1112 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1113 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1114 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1115 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1116
1117 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1118 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1119 the @option{-rpath} option.
1120
1121 @kindex -s
1122 @kindex --strip-all
1123 @cindex strip all symbols
1124 @item -s
1125 @itemx --strip-all
1126 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1127
1128 @kindex -S
1129 @kindex --strip-debug
1130 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1131 @item -S
1132 @itemx --strip-debug
1133 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1134
1135 @kindex --strip-discarded
1136 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1137 @item --strip-discarded
1138 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1139 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1140 Enabled by default.
1141
1142 @kindex -t
1143 @kindex --trace
1144 @cindex input files, displaying
1145 @item -t
1146 @itemx --trace
1147 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1148 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1149 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1150 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1151 a linker bug report.
1152
1153 @kindex -T @var{script}
1154 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1155 @cindex script files
1156 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1157 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1158 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1159 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1160 unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
1161 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1162 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1163 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1164 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1165 options accumulate.
1166
1167 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1168 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1169 @cindex script files
1170 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1171 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1172 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1173
1174 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1175 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1176 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1177 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1178 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1179 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1180 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1181 @samp{gcc}).
1182
1183 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1184 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1185 @cindex undefined symbol
1186 @item -u @var{symbol}
1187 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1188 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1189 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1190 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1191 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1192 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1193
1194 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1195 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1196 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1197 instead.
1198
1199 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1200 @cindex symbols, require defined
1201 @cindex defined symbol
1202 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1203 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1204 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1205 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1206 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1207 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1208 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1209
1210 @kindex -Ur
1211 @cindex constructors
1212 @item -Ur
1213
1214 For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1215 based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1216 relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1217 input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1218 option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1219 constructors and destructors.
1220
1221 For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1222 differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1223 themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1224 been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1225 partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
1226
1227 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1228 @cindex orphan sections
1229 @cindex sections, orphan
1230 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1231 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1232 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1233
1234 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1235
1236 @table @code
1237 @item place
1238 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1239 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1240 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1241
1242 @item discard
1243 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1244 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1245
1246 @item warn
1247 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1248 issue a warning.
1249
1250 @item error
1251 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1252 @end table
1253
1254 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1255
1256 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1257 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1258 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1259 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1260 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1261 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1262 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1263 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1264 in a linker script.
1265
1266 @kindex -v
1267 @kindex -V
1268 @kindex --version
1269 @cindex version
1270 @item -v
1271 @itemx --version
1272 @itemx -V
1273 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1274 lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1275 @option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1276 which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
1277
1278 @kindex -x
1279 @kindex --discard-all
1280 @cindex deleting local symbols
1281 @item -x
1282 @itemx --discard-all
1283 Delete all local symbols.
1284
1285 @kindex -X
1286 @kindex --discard-locals
1287 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1288 @item -X
1289 @itemx --discard-locals
1290 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1291 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1292 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1293
1294 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1295 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1296 @cindex symbol tracing
1297 @item -y @var{symbol}
1298 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1299 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1300 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1301 to prepend an underscore.
1302
1303 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1304 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1305
1306 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1307 @item -Y @var{path}
1308 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1309 for Solaris compatibility.
1310
1311 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1312 @item -z @var{keyword}
1313 The recognized keywords are:
1314 @table @samp
1315
1316 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1317 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1318 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1319 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1320 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1321 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1322 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1323 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1324 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1325 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1326 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1327
1328 @item cet-report=none
1329 @itemx cet-report=warning
1330 @itemx cet-report=error
1331 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1332 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1333 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1334 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1335 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1336 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1337 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1338 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1339 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1340 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1341 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1342
1343 @item combreloc
1344 @itemx nocombreloc
1345 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1346 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1347
1348 @item common
1349 @itemx nocommon
1350 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1351 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1352
1353 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1354 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1355 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1356 using pages of this size.
1357
1358 @item defs
1359 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1360 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1361 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1362
1363 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1364 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1365 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1366 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1367 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1368 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1369 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1370 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1371 these options.
1372
1373 @item execstack
1374 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1375
1376 @item global
1377 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1378 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1379 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1380
1381 @item globalaudit
1382 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1383 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1384 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1385 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1386 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1387 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1388
1389 @item ibtplt
1390 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1391 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1392
1393 @item ibt
1394 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1395 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1396 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1397
1398 @item indirect-extern-access
1399 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1400 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1401 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1402 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1403 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1404 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1405
1406 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1407 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1408 section.
1409
1410 @item initfirst
1411 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1412 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1413 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1414 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1415 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1416 objects.
1417
1418 @item interpose
1419 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1420 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1421 libraries not so marked.
1422
1423 @item unique
1424 @itemx nounique
1425 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1426 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1427 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1428 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1429 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1430 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1431 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1432
1433 @item lam-u48
1434 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1435 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1436
1437 @item lam-u57
1438 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1439 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1440
1441 @item lam-u48-report=none
1442 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1443 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1444 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1445 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1446 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1447 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1448 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1449 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1450 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1451 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1452
1453 @item lam-u57-report=none
1454 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1455 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1456 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1457 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1458 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1459 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1460 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1461 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1462 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1463 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1464
1465 @item lam-report=none
1466 @itemx lam-report=warning
1467 @itemx lam-report=error
1468 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1469 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1470 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1471 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1472 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1473 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1474 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1475 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1476
1477 @item lazy
1478 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1479 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1480 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1481 Lazy binding is the default.
1482
1483 @item loadfltr
1484 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1485
1486 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1487 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1488
1489 @item mark-plt
1490 @itemx nomark-plt
1491 Mark PLT entries with dynamic tags, DT_X86_64_PLT, DT_X86_64_PLTSZ and
1492 DT_X86_64_PLTENT. Since this option stores a non-zero value in the
1493 r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, the resulting
1494 executables and shared libraries are incompatible with dynamic linkers,
1495 such as those in older versions of glibc without the change to ignore
1496 r_addend in R_X86_64_GLOB_DAT and R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations, which
1497 don't ignore the r_addend field of R_X86_64_JUMP_SLOT relocations.
1498 Supported for x86_64.
1499
1500 @item muldefs
1501 Allow multiple definitions.
1502
1503 @item nocopyreloc
1504 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1505 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1506
1507 @item nodefaultlib
1508 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1509 should ignore any default library search paths.
1510
1511 @item nodelete
1512 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1513
1514 @item nodlopen
1515 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1516
1517 @item nodump
1518 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1519
1520 @item noexecstack
1521 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1522
1523 @item noextern-protected-data
1524 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1525 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1526 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1527 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1528 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1529 i386 and x86-64.
1530
1531 @item noreloc-overflow
1532 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1533 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1534 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1535
1536 @item now
1537 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1538 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1539 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1540 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1541 called.
1542
1543 @item origin
1544 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1545
1546 @item pack-relative-relocs
1547 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1548 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1549 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1550 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1551 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1552 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1553 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1554 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1555 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1556
1557 @item relro
1558 @itemx norelro
1559 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1560 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1561 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1562 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1563 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1564
1565 @item report-relative-reloc
1566 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1567 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1568
1569 @item sectionheader
1570 @itemx nosectionheader
1571 Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1572 @samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1573
1574 @item separate-code
1575 @itemx noseparate-code
1576 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1577 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1578 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1579 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1580
1581 @item shstk
1582 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1583 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1584 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1585
1586 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1587 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1588 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1589 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1590
1591 @item start-stop-gc
1592 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1593 @cindex start-stop-gc
1594 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1595 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1596 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1597 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1598 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1599 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1600 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1601 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1602 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1603 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1604 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1605 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1606 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1607
1608 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1609 @cindex visibility
1610 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1611 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1612 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1613 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1614 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1615 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1616 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1617 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1618 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1619 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1620
1621 @item text
1622 @itemx notext
1623 @itemx textoff
1624 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1625 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1626 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1627
1628 @item undefs
1629 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1630 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1631 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1632
1633 @item unique-symbol
1634 @itemx nounique-symbol
1635 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1636 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1637 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1638
1639 @item x86-64-baseline
1640 @item x86-64-v2
1641 @item x86-64-v3
1642 @itemx x86-64-v4
1643 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1644 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1645 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1646 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1647 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1648 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1649
1650 @end table
1651
1652 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1653
1654 @kindex -(
1655 @cindex groups of archives
1656 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1657 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1658 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1659 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1660
1661 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1662 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1663 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1664 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1665 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1666 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1667 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1668 resolved.
1669
1670 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1671 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1672 more archives.
1673
1674 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1675 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1676 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1677 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1678 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1679 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1680 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1681 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1682 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1683 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1684 restore the old behaviour.
1685
1686 @kindex --as-needed
1687 @kindex --no-as-needed
1688 @item --as-needed
1689 @itemx --no-as-needed
1690 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1691 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1692 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1693 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1694 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1695 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1696 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1697 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1698 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1699 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1700 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1701 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1702 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1703
1704 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1705 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1706 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1707 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1708
1709 @kindex --add-needed
1710 @kindex --no-add-needed
1711 @item --add-needed
1712 @itemx --no-add-needed
1713 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1714 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1715 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1716 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1717
1718 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1719 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1720 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1721
1722 @kindex -Bdynamic
1723 @kindex -dy
1724 @kindex -call_shared
1725 @item -Bdynamic
1726 @itemx -dy
1727 @itemx -call_shared
1728 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1729 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1730 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1731 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1732 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1733 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1734
1735 @kindex -Bgroup
1736 @item -Bgroup
1737 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1738 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1739 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1740 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1741 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1742
1743 @kindex -Bstatic
1744 @kindex -dn
1745 @kindex -non_shared
1746 @kindex -static
1747 @item -Bstatic
1748 @itemx -dn
1749 @itemx -non_shared
1750 @itemx -static
1751 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1752 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1753 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1754 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1755 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1756 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1757 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1758 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1759 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1760 libraries.
1761
1762 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1763 @item -Bsymbolic
1764 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1765 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1766 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1767 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1768 platforms which support shared libraries.
1769
1770 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1771 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1772 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1773 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1774 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1775 libraries.
1776
1777 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1778 @item -Bno-symbolic
1779 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1780 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1781
1782 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1783 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1784 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1785 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1786 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1787 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1788 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1789 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1790 which support shared libraries.
1791
1792 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1793 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1794
1795 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1796 @item --dynamic-list-data
1797 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1798
1799 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1800 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1801 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1802 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1803
1804 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1805 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1806 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1807
1808 @kindex --check-sections
1809 @kindex --no-check-sections
1810 @item --check-sections
1811 @itemx --no-check-sections
1812 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1813 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1814 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1815 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1816 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1817 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1818 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1819 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1820 option.
1821
1822 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1823 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1824 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1825 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1826 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1827 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1828 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1829 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1830 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1831 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1832 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1833 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1834
1835 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1836 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1837 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1838 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1839 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1840 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1841 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1842 symbols.
1843
1844 @cindex cross reference table
1845 @kindex --cref
1846 @item --cref
1847 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1848 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1849 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1850
1851 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1852 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1853 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1854 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1855 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1856 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1857 symbol are listed.
1858
1859 @cindex ctf variables
1860 @kindex --ctf-variables
1861 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1862 @item --ctf-variables
1863 @item --no-ctf-variables
1864 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1865 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1866 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1867 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1868 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1869 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1870 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1871
1872 @cindex ctf type sharing
1873 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1874 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1875 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1876
1877 @table @samp
1878 @item share-unconflicted
1879 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1880 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1881 translation unit. This is the default.
1882
1883 @item share-duplicated
1884 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1885 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1886 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1887 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1888 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1889 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1890 consumer at runtime.
1891 @end table
1892
1893 @cindex common allocation
1894 @kindex --no-define-common
1895 @item --no-define-common
1896 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1897 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1898 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1899
1900 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1901 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1902 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1903 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1904 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1905 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1906 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1907 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1908 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1909 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1910
1911 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1912 @cindex section groups
1913 @cindex COMDAT
1914 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1915 @item --force-group-allocation
1916 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1917 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1918 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1919 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1920 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1921 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1922
1923 @cindex symbols, from command line
1924 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1925 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1926 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1927 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1928 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1929 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1930 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1931 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1932 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1933 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1934 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1935 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1936
1937 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1938 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1939 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1940 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1941 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1942 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1943 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1944 you are trying to achieve.
1945
1946 @cindex demangling, from command line
1947 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1948 @kindex --no-demangle
1949 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1950 @itemx --no-demangle
1951 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1952 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1953 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1954 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1955 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1956 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1957 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1958 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1959 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1960
1961 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1962 @kindex -I@var{file}
1963 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1964 @item -I@var{file}
1965 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1966 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1967 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1968 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1969 doing.
1970
1971 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1972 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1973 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1974 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1975 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1976 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1977
1978 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1979 @item --embedded-relocs
1980 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1981 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1982 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1983 targets.
1984
1985 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1986 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1987 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1988 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1989
1990 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1991 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1992 @item --fatal-warnings
1993 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1994 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1995 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1996
1997 @kindex -w
1998 @kindex --no-warnings
1999 @item -w
2000 @itemx --no-warnings
2001 Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
2002 @option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
2003 used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
2004 is still a need to create it.
2005
2006 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
2007 @item --force-exe-suffix
2008 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
2009
2010 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
2011 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
2012 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
2013 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
2014 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
2015 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
2016
2017 @kindex --gc-sections
2018 @kindex --no-gc-sections
2019 @cindex garbage collection
2020 @item --gc-sections
2021 @itemx --no-gc-sections
2022 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
2023 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
2024 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
2025 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2026 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2027 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
2028
2029 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2030 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2031 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2032 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2033 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2034 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2035 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2036 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
2037 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2038 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
2039
2040 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
2041 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
2042 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2043 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2044 command in the linker script.
2045
2046 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2047 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2048
2049 @kindex --print-gc-sections
2050 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2051 @cindex garbage collection
2052 @item --print-gc-sections
2053 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2054 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2055 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2056 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2057 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2058 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2059 line.
2060
2061 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
2062 @cindex garbage collection
2063 @item --gc-keep-exported
2064 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2065 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2066 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2067 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2068 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2069 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2070 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2071 ELF format targets.
2072
2073 @kindex --print-output-format
2074 @cindex output format
2075 @item --print-output-format
2076 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2077 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2078 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2079
2080 @kindex --print-memory-usage
2081 @cindex memory usage
2082 @item --print-memory-usage
2083 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2084 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2085 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2086 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2087 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2088
2089 @smallexample
2090 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2091 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2092 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2093 @end smallexample
2094
2095 @cindex help
2096 @cindex usage
2097 @kindex --help
2098 @item --help
2099 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2100
2101 @kindex --target-help
2102 @item --target-help
2103 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
2104
2105 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2106 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
2107 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2108 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2109 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2110
2111 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2112 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2113 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2114 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2115 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2116 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2117 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2118
2119 @smallexample
2120 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2121 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2122 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2123 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2124 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2125 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2126 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2127 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2128 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2129 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2130 @end smallexample
2131
2132 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2133
2134 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2135 operation.
2136
2137 @cindex memory usage
2138 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2139 @item --no-keep-memory
2140 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2141 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2142 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2143 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2144 while linking a large executable.
2145
2146 @kindex --no-undefined
2147 @kindex -z defs
2148 @kindex -z undefs
2149 @item --no-undefined
2150 @itemx -z defs
2151 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2152 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2153 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2154 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2155 libraries being linked in.
2156
2157 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2158
2159 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2160 @kindex -z muldefs
2161 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2162 @itemx -z muldefs
2163 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2164 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2165 first definition will be used.
2166
2167 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2168 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2169 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2170 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2171 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2172 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2173 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2174 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2175 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2176
2177 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2178 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2179 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2180 a shared library.
2181
2182 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2183 libraries specified at link time are that:
2184
2185 @itemize @bullet
2186 @item
2187 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2188 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2189 resolvable at load time.
2190 @item
2191 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2192 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2193
2194 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2195 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2196 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2197 appropriate memset function.
2198 @end itemize
2199
2200 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2201 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2202 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2203 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2204 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2205 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2206 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2207 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2208 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2209 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2210 error message will be displayed.
2211
2212 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2213 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2214
2215 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2216 @item --no-undefined-version
2217 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2218 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2219 will be issued instead.
2220
2221 @kindex --default-symver
2222 @item --default-symver
2223 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2224 exported symbols.
2225
2226 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2227 @item --default-imported-symver
2228 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2229 imported symbols.
2230
2231 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2232 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2233 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2234 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2235 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2236 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2237 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2238 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2239 inappropriate.
2240
2241 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2242 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2243 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2244 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2245
2246 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2247 @item --no-whole-archive
2248 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2249 archive files.
2250
2251 @cindex output file after errors
2252 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2253 @item --noinhibit-exec
2254 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2255 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2256 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2257 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2258
2259 @kindex -nostdlib
2260 @item -nostdlib
2261 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2262 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2263 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2264
2265 @ifclear SingleFormat
2266 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2267 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2268 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2269 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2270 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2271 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2272 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2273 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2274 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2275 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2276 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2277 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2278 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2279 @end ifclear
2280
2281 @kindex --out-implib
2282 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2283 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2284 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2285 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2286 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2287 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2288 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2289 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2290
2291 @kindex -pie
2292 @kindex --pic-executable
2293 @item -pie
2294 @itemx --pic-executable
2295 @cindex position independent executables
2296 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2297 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2298 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2299 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2300 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2301 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2302
2303 @kindex -no-pie
2304 @item -no-pie
2305 @cindex position dependent executables
2306 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2307
2308 @kindex -qmagic
2309 @item -qmagic
2310 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2311
2312 @kindex -Qy
2313 @item -Qy
2314 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2315
2316 @kindex --relax
2317 @cindex synthesizing linker
2318 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2319 @cindex --no-relax
2320 @item --relax
2321 @itemx --no-relax
2322 An option with machine dependent effects.
2323 @ifset GENERIC
2324 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2325 @end ifset
2326 @ifset H8300
2327 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2328 @end ifset
2329 @ifset XTENSA
2330 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2331 @end ifset
2332 @ifset M68HC11
2333 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2334 @end ifset
2335 @ifset NIOSII
2336 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2337 @end ifset
2338 @ifset POWERPC
2339 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2340 @end ifset
2341
2342 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2343 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2344 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2345 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2346 instructions, and combining constant values.
2347
2348 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2349 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2350 @ifset GENERIC
2351 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2352 family of processors.
2353 @end ifset
2354
2355 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2356 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2357
2358 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2359 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2360
2361 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2362 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2363 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2364 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2365 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2366 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2367 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2368 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2369 @ifset GENERIC
2370 (such as VxWorks)
2371 @end ifset
2372 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2373 run-time memory.
2374
2375 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2376 or symbols needed for relocations.
2377
2378 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2379 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2380
2381 @ifset GENERIC
2382 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2383 @cindex runtime library search path
2384 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2385 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2386 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2387 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2388 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2389
2390 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2391 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2392 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2393 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2394 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2395
2396 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2397 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2398 is defined.
2399
2400 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2401 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2402 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2403 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2404 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2405 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2406 file systems.
2407
2408 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2409 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2410 the @option{-rpath} option.
2411 @end ifset
2412
2413 @ifset GENERIC
2414 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2415 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2416 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2417 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2418 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2419 of the input files.
2420
2421 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2422 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2423 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2424 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2425 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2426 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2427 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2428 appearing multiple times.
2429
2430 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2431 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2432 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2433 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2434 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2435
2436 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2437 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2438 supported.
2439
2440 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2441 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2442 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2443 runtime linker would do.
2444
2445 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2446 libraries:
2447
2448 @enumerate
2449 @item
2450 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2451 @item
2452 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2453 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2454 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2455 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2456 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2457 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2458 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2459 @item
2460 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2461 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2462 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2463 @item
2464 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2465 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2466 @item
2467 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2468 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2469 @item
2470 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2471 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2472 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2473 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2474 @item
2475 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2476 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2477 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2478 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2479 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2480 @item
2481 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2482 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2483 header file.
2484 @item
2485 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2486 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2487 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2488 @item
2489 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2490 @item
2491 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2492 @item
2493 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2494 linker script.
2495 @end enumerate
2496
2497 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2498 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2499 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2500 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2501 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2502 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2503 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2504 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2505 of the first.
2506
2507 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2508 warning and continue with the link.
2509
2510 @end ifset
2511
2512 @kindex -shared
2513 @kindex -Bshareable
2514 @item -shared
2515 @itemx -Bshareable
2516 @cindex shared libraries
2517 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2518 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2519 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2520 undefined symbols in the link.
2521
2522 @kindex --sort-common
2523 @item --sort-common
2524 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2525 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2526 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2527 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2528 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2529 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2530 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2531 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2532
2533 @kindex --sort-section=name
2534 @item --sort-section=name
2535 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2536 patterns in the linker script.
2537
2538 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2539 @item --sort-section=alignment
2540 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2541 patterns in the linker script.
2542
2543 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2544 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2545 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2546 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2547 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2548
2549 @kindex --split-by-file
2550 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2551 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2552 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2553 size of 1 if not given.
2554
2555 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2556 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2557 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2558 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2559 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2560 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2561 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2562 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2563 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2564 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2565 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2566 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2567
2568 @kindex --stats
2569 @item --stats
2570 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2571 as execution time and memory usage.
2572
2573 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2574 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2575 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2576 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2577 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2578
2579 @kindex --task-link
2580 @item --task-link
2581 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2582 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2583
2584 @kindex --traditional-format
2585 @cindex traditional format
2586 @item --traditional-format
2587 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2588 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2589 use the traditional format instead.
2590
2591 @cindex dbx
2592 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2593 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2594 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2595 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2596 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2597 combine duplicate entries.
2598
2599 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2600 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2601 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2602 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2603 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2604 line.
2605 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2606 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2607 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2608 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2609 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2610
2611 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2612 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2613 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2614 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2615 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2616 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2617 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2618 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2619 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2620
2621 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2622 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2623 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2624 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2625 byte of the text segment.
2626
2627 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2628 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2629 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2630 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2631 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2632 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2633
2634 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2635 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2636 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2637 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2638 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2639
2640 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2641 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2642 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2643 values for @samp{method}:
2644
2645 @table @samp
2646 @item ignore-all
2647 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2648
2649 @item report-all
2650 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2651
2652 @item ignore-in-object-files
2653 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2654 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2655
2656 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2657 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2658 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2659 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2660 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2661 command line.
2662 @end table
2663
2664 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2665 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2666
2667 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2668 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2669 can change this to a warning.
2670
2671 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2672 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2673 @item --dll-verbose
2674 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2675 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2676 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2677 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2678 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2679
2680 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2681 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2682 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2683 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2684 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2685 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2686 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2687 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2688 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2689 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2690 @xref{WIN32}.
2691
2692 @kindex --warn-common
2693 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2694 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2695 @item --warn-common
2696 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2697 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2698 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2699 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2700 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2701 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2702
2703 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2704
2705 @table @samp
2706 @item int i = 1;
2707 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2708 file.
2709
2710 @item extern int i;
2711 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2712 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2713 variable somewhere.
2714
2715 @item int i;
2716 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2717 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2718 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2719 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2720 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2721 a definition of the same variable.
2722 @end table
2723
2724 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2725 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2726 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2727 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2728 a common symbol.
2729
2730 @enumerate
2731 @item
2732 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2733 definition for the symbol.
2734 @smallexample
2735 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2736 overridden by definition
2737 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2738 @end smallexample
2739
2740 @item
2741 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2742 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2743 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2744 @smallexample
2745 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2746 overriding common
2747 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2748 @end smallexample
2749
2750 @item
2751 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2752 @smallexample
2753 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2754 of `@var{symbol}'
2755 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2756 @end smallexample
2757
2758 @item
2759 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2760 @smallexample
2761 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2762 overridden by larger common
2763 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2764 @end smallexample
2765
2766 @item
2767 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2768 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2769 encountered in a different order.
2770 @smallexample
2771 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2772 overriding smaller common
2773 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2774 @end smallexample
2775 @end enumerate
2776
2777 @kindex --warn-constructors
2778 @item --warn-constructors
2779 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2780 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2781 detect the use of global constructors.
2782
2783 @kindex --warn-execstack
2784 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2785 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2786 @item --warn-execstack
2787 @itemx --warn-execstack-objects
2788 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2789 On ELF platforms the linker may generate warning messages if it is
2790 asked to create an output file that contains an executable stack.
2791 There are three possible states:
2792 @enumerate
2793 @item
2794 Do not generate any warnings.
2795 @item
2796 Always generate warnings, even if the executable stack is requested
2797 via the @option{-z execstack} command line option.
2798 @item
2799 Only generate a warning if an object file requests an executable
2800 stack, but not if the @option{-z execstack} option is used.
2801 @end enumerate
2802
2803 The default state depends upon how the linker was configured when it
2804 was built. The @option{--no-warn-execstack} option always puts the
2805 linker into the no-warnings state. The @option{--warn-execstack}
2806 option puts the linker into the warn-always state. The
2807 @option{--warn-execstack-objects} option puts the linker into the
2808 warn-for-object-files-only state.
2809
2810 Note: ELF format input files can specify that they need an executable
2811 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2812 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2813 an executable stack by having the same section, but without the
2814 executable flag bit set. If an input file does not have a
2815 @var{.note.GNU-stack} section then the default behaviour is target
2816 specific. For some targets, then absence of such a section implies
2817 that an executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem
2818 for hand crafted assembler files.
2819
2820 @kindex --error-execstack
2821 @item --error-execstack
2822 @itemx --no-error-execstack
2823 If the linker is going to generate a warning message about an
2824 executable stack then the @option{--error-execstack} option will
2825 instead change that warning into an error. Note - this option does
2826 not change the linker's execstack warning generation state. Use
2827 @option{--warn-execstack} or @option{--warn-execstack-objects} to set
2828 a specific warning state.
2829
2830 The @option{--no-error-execstack} option will restore the default
2831 behaviour of generating warning messages.
2832
2833 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2834 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2835 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2836 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2837 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2838 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2839 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2840 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2841 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2842 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2843 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2844 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2845 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2846
2847 @kindex --warn-once
2848 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2849 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2850 @item --warn-once
2851 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2852 which refers to it.
2853
2854 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2855 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2856 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2857 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2858 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2859 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2860 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2861 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2862 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2863 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2864 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2865
2866 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2867 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2868 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2869
2870 @kindex --error-rwx-segments
2871 @item --error-rwx-segments
2872 @itemx --no-error-rwx-segments
2873 If the linker is going to generate a warning message about an
2874 executable, writeable segment, or an executable TLS segment, then the
2875 @option{--error-rwx-segments} option will turn this warning into an
2876 error instead. The @option{--no-error-rwx-segments} option will
2877 restore the default behaviour of just generating a warning message.
2878
2879 Note - the @option{--error-rwx-segments} option does not by itself
2880 turn on warnings about these segments. These warnings are either
2881 enabled by default, if the linker was configured that way, or via the
2882 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} command line option.
2883
2884 @kindex --warn-section-align
2885 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2886 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2887 @item --warn-section-align
2888 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2889 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2890 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2891 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2892 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2893
2894 @kindex --warn-textrel
2895 @item --warn-textrel
2896 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2897 or shared object.
2898
2899 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2900 @item --warn-alternate-em
2901 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2902
2903 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2904 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2905 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2906 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2907 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2908
2909 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2910 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2911 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2912 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2913
2914 @kindex --whole-archive
2915 @cindex including an entire archive
2916 @item --whole-archive
2917 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2918 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2919 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2920 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2921 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2922 library. This option may be used more than once.
2923
2924 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2925 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2926 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2927 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2928 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2929
2930 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2931 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2932 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2933 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2934 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2935 @var{symbol}.
2936
2937 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2938 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2939 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2940 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2941
2942 Here is a trivial example:
2943
2944 @smallexample
2945 void *
2946 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2947 @{
2948 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2949 return __real_malloc (c);
2950 @}
2951 @end smallexample
2952
2953 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2954 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2955 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2956 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2957
2958 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2959 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2960 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2961 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2962 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2963
2964 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2965 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2966 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2967 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2968
2969 @smallexample
2970 int
2971 f (void)
2972 @{
2973 return 123;
2974 @}
2975
2976 int
2977 g (void)
2978 @{
2979 return f();
2980 @}
2981 @end smallexample
2982
2983 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2984 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2985 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2986 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2987 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2988 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2989 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2990
2991 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2992 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2993 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2994 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2995 if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
2996 controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
2997 generated code sections like PLT.
2998
2999 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
3000 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
3001 @item --enable-new-dtags
3002 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
3003 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
3004 systems may not understand them. If you specify
3005 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
3006 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
3007 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
3008 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
3009 those options are only available for ELF systems.
3010
3011 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
3012 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
3013 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
3014 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
3015 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
3016 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
3017 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
3018
3019 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
3020 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
3021 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
3022 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
3023 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
3024 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
3025 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
3026 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
3027
3028 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
3029 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
3030 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
3031 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
3032 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
3033 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
3034 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
3035 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
3036 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
3037 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
3038 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
3039 compressed using zlib.
3040
3041 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
3042 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
3043 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
3044 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
3045 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
3046 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
3047
3048 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
3049 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
3050
3051 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
3052 zstd.
3053
3054 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
3055 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
3056 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
3057 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
3058
3059 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3060 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3061 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3062 @option{--help} option.
3063
3064 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3065 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
3066 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
3067 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
3068 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
3069 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3070
3071 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
3072 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
3073 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
3074 has been used.
3075
3076 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3077 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
3078
3079 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3080 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3081 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3082 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3083 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3084
3085 @kindex --build-id
3086 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3087 @item --build-id
3088 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
3089 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
3090 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
3091 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3092 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3093 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3094 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3095 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3096 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3097 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3098 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
3099
3100 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3101 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3102 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3103 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3104 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3105 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
3106
3107 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3108 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
3109
3110 @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3111 @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3112 Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3113 contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3114 specification. For more information see:
3115 https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3116 If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3117 creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
3118 occurrence of the --package-metadata option.
3119 If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3120 will be validated.
3121 @end table
3122
3123 @c man end
3124
3125 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
3126
3127 @c man begin OPTIONS
3128
3129 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
3130 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3131 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3132 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3133 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3134 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3135 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3136 object file).
3137
3138 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
3139 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
3140 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3141 values by either a space or an equals sign.
3142
3143 @table @gcctabopt
3144
3145 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3146 @item --add-stdcall-alias
3147 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3148 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
3149 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3150
3151 @kindex --base-file
3152 @item --base-file @var{file}
3153 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3154 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3155 @file{dlltool}.
3156 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
3157
3158 @kindex --dll
3159 @item --dll
3160 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
3161 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
3162 file.
3163 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3164
3165 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
3166 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
3167 @item --enable-long-section-names
3168 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
3169 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
3170 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
3171 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3172 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
3173 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3174 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3175 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3176 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3177 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
3178 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3179 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3180 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3181 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3182 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3183 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3184 image and not stripping symbols.
3185 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3186
3187 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3188 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3189 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3190 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3191 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3192 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3193 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3194 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3195 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3196 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3197 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3198 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3199 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3200 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3201 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3202 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3203 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3204 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3205
3206 @kindex --leading-underscore
3207 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3208 @item --leading-underscore
3209 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3210 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3211 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3212 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3213
3214 @cindex DLLs, creating
3215 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3216 @item --export-all-symbols
3217 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3218 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3219 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3220 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3221 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3222 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3223 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3224 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3225 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3226 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3227 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3228 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3229 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3230 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3231 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3232 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3233 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3234 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3235 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3236 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3237 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3238 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3239 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3240
3241 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3242 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3243 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3244 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3245 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3246
3247 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3248 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3249 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3250 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3251
3252 @kindex --file-alignment
3253 @item --file-alignment
3254 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3255 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3256 512.
3257 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3258
3259 @cindex heap size
3260 @kindex --heap
3261 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3262 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3263 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3264 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3265 committed.
3266 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3267
3268 @cindex image base
3269 @kindex --image-base
3270 @item --image-base @var{value}
3271 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3272 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3273 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3274 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3275 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3276 for dlls.
3277 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3278
3279 @kindex --kill-at
3280 @item --kill-at
3281 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3282 symbols before they are exported.
3283 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3284
3285 @kindex --large-address-aware
3286 @item --large-address-aware
3287 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3288 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3289 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3290 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3291 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3292 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3293
3294 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3295 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3296 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3297 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3298 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3299 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3300 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3301
3302 @kindex --major-image-version
3303 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3304 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3305 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3306
3307 @kindex --major-os-version
3308 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3309 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3310 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3311
3312 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3313 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3314 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3315 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3316
3317 @kindex --minor-image-version
3318 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3319 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3320 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3321
3322 @kindex --minor-os-version
3323 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3324 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3325 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3326
3327 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3328 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3329 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3330 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3331
3332 @cindex DEF files, creating
3333 @cindex DLLs, creating
3334 @kindex --output-def
3335 @item --output-def @var{file}
3336 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3337 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3338 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3339 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3340 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3341 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3342
3343 @cindex DLLs, creating
3344 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3345 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3346 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3347 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3348 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3349 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3350 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3351 execution are avoided.
3352 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3353
3354 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3355 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3356 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3357 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3358 default.
3359 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3360
3361 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3362 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3363 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3364 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3365 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3366 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3367 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3368 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3369 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3370 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3371
3372 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3373 @item --enable-auto-import
3374 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3375 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3376 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3377 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3378
3379 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3380 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3381
3382 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3383 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3384 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3385
3386 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3387 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3388 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3389 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3390 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3391
3392 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3393 see this message:
3394
3395 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3396 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3397
3398 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3399 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3400 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3401 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3402 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3403 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3404 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3405 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3406 the warning, and exit.
3407
3408 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3409 data type of the exported variable:
3410
3411 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3412 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3413 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3414
3415 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3416 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3417 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3418 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3419
3420 @example
3421 extern type extern_array[];
3422 extern_array[1] -->
3423 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3424 @end example
3425
3426 or
3427
3428 @example
3429 extern type extern_array[];
3430 extern_array[1] -->
3431 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3432 @end example
3433
3434 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3435 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3436
3437 @example
3438 extern struct s extern_struct;
3439 extern_struct.field -->
3440 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3441 @end example
3442
3443 or
3444
3445 @example
3446 extern long long extern_ll;
3447 extern_ll -->
3448 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3449 @end example
3450
3451 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3452 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3453 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3454 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3455 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3456 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3457 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3458 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3459
3460 Original:
3461 @example
3462 --foo.h
3463 extern int arr[];
3464 --foo.c
3465 #include "foo.h"
3466 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3467 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3468 @}
3469 @end example
3470
3471 Solution 1:
3472 @example
3473 --foo.h
3474 extern int arr[];
3475 --foo.c
3476 #include "foo.h"
3477 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3478 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3479 volatile int *parr = arr;
3480 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3481 @}
3482 @end example
3483
3484 Solution 2:
3485 @example
3486 --foo.h
3487 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3488 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3489 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3490 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3491 #else
3492 #define FOO_IMPORT
3493 #endif
3494 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3495 --foo.c
3496 #include "foo.h"
3497 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3498 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3499 @}
3500 @end example
3501
3502 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3503 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3504 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3505 functions).
3506
3507 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3508 @item --disable-auto-import
3509 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3510 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3511 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3512
3513 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3514 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3515 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3516 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3517 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3518 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3519 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3520
3521 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3522 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3523 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3524 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3525
3526 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3527 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3528 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3529 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3530
3531 @kindex --section-alignment
3532 @item --section-alignment
3533 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3534 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3535 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3536
3537 @cindex stack size
3538 @kindex --stack
3539 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3540 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3541 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3542 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3543 committed.
3544 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3545
3546 @kindex --subsystem
3547 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3548 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3549 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3550 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3551 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3552 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3553 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3554 @var{which}.
3555 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3556
3557 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3558 of the PE file header:
3559 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3560
3561 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3562 @item --high-entropy-va
3563 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3564 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3565 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3566
3567 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3568 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3569
3570 @kindex --dynamicbase
3571 @item --dynamicbase
3572 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3573 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3574 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3575 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3576 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3577 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3578
3579 @kindex --forceinteg
3580 @item --forceinteg
3581 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3582 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3583 default.
3584
3585 @kindex --nxcompat
3586 @item --nxcompat
3587 @item --disable-nxcompat
3588 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3589 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3590 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3591
3592 @kindex --no-isolation
3593 @item --no-isolation
3594 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3595 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3596 This option is disabled by default.
3597
3598 @kindex --no-seh
3599 @item --no-seh
3600 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3601 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3602 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3603
3604 @kindex --no-bind
3605 @item --no-bind
3606 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3607 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3608
3609 @kindex --wdmdriver
3610 @item --wdmdriver
3611 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3612 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3613 by default.
3614
3615 @kindex --tsaware
3616 @item --tsaware
3617 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3618 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3619 default.
3620
3621 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3622 @item --insert-timestamp
3623 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3624 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3625 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3626 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3627 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3628 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3629 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3630 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3631 identically.
3632
3633 If @option{--insert-timestamp} is active then the time inserted is
3634 either the time that the linking takes place or, if the
3635 @code{SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH} environment variable is defined, the number
3636 of seconds since Unix epoch as specified by that variable.
3637
3638 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3639 @item --enable-reloc-section
3640 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3641 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3642 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3643 This option is enabled by default.
3644 @end table
3645
3646 @c man end
3647
3648 @ifset C6X
3649 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3650
3651 @c man begin OPTIONS
3652
3653 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3654 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3655 all executables use an index of 0.
3656
3657 @table @gcctabopt
3658
3659 @kindex --dsbt-size
3660 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3661 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3662 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3663 entries.
3664
3665 @kindex --dsbt-index
3666 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3667 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3668 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3669 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3670 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3671
3672 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3673 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3674 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3675
3676 @end table
3677
3678 @c man end
3679 @end ifset
3680
3681 @ifset CSKY
3682 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3683
3684 @c man begin OPTIONS
3685
3686 @table @gcctabopt
3687
3688 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3689 @item --branch-stub
3690 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3691 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3692 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3693 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3694 the compiler or assembler.
3695
3696 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3697 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3698 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3699 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3700 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3701 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3702 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3703 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3704 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3705
3706 @end table
3707
3708 @c man end
3709 @end ifset
3710
3711 @ifset M68HC11
3712 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3713
3714 @c man begin OPTIONS
3715
3716 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3717 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3718
3719 @table @gcctabopt
3720
3721 @kindex --no-trampoline
3722 @item --no-trampoline
3723 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3724 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3725 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3726
3727 @kindex --bank-window
3728 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3729 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3730 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3731 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3732 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3733
3734 @end table
3735
3736 @c man end
3737 @end ifset
3738
3739 @ifset M68K
3740 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3741
3742 @c man begin OPTIONS
3743
3744 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3745 when linking for 68K targets.
3746
3747 @table @gcctabopt
3748
3749 @kindex --got
3750 @item --got=@var{type}
3751 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3752 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3753 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3754 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3755
3756 @end table
3757
3758 @c man end
3759 @end ifset
3760
3761 @ifset MIPS
3762 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3763
3764 @c man begin OPTIONS
3765
3766 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3767 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3768 linking for MIPS targets.
3769
3770 @table @gcctabopt
3771
3772 @kindex --insn32
3773 @item --insn32
3774 @kindex --no-insn32
3775 @itemx --no-insn32
3776 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3777 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3778 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3779 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3780 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3781 possible.
3782
3783 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3784 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3785 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3786 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3787 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3788 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3789 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3790 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3791 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3792 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3793 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3794 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3795 an error.
3796
3797 @kindex --compact-branches
3798 @item --compact-branches
3799 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3800 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3801 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3802 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3803
3804 @end table
3805
3806 @c man end
3807 @end ifset
3808
3809
3810 @ifset PDP11
3811 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3812
3813 @c man begin OPTIONS
3814
3815 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3816 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3817 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3818 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3819 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3820 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3821
3822 @table @gcctabopt
3823
3824 @kindex -N
3825 @item -N
3826 @kindex --omagic
3827 @itemx --omagic
3828
3829 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3830 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3831 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3832 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3833 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3834 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3835 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3836
3837 @kindex -n
3838 @item -n
3839 @kindex --nmagic
3840 @itemx --nmagic
3841
3842 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3843 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3844 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3845 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3846 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3847 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3848
3849 @kindex -z
3850 @item -z
3851 @kindex --imagic
3852 @itemx --imagic
3853
3854 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3855 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3856 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3857 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3858 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3859 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3860 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3861 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3862 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3863 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3864 executable} format.
3865
3866 @kindex --no-omagic
3867 @item --no-omagic
3868
3869 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3870
3871 @end table
3872
3873 @c man end
3874 @end ifset
3875
3876 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3877 @node Environment
3878 @section Environment Variables
3879
3880 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3881
3882 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3883 @ifclear SingleFormat
3884 @code{GNUTARGET},
3885 @end ifclear
3886 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3887
3888 @ifclear SingleFormat
3889 @kindex GNUTARGET
3890 @cindex default input format
3891 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3892 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3893 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3894 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3895 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3896 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3897 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3898 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3899 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3900 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3901 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3902 @end ifclear
3903
3904 @kindex LDEMULATION
3905 @cindex default emulation
3906 @cindex emulation, default
3907 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3908 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3909 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3910 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3911 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3912 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3913 linker was configured.
3914
3915 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3916 @cindex demangling, default
3917 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3918 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3919 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3920 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3921 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3922 options.
3923
3924 @c man end
3925 @end ifset
3926
3927 @node Scripts
3928 @chapter Linker Scripts
3929
3930 @cindex scripts
3931 @cindex linker scripts
3932 @cindex command files
3933 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3934 written in the linker command language.
3935
3936 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3937 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3938 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3939 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3940 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3941 described below.
3942
3943 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3944 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3945 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3946 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3947 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3948
3949 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3950 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3951 default linker script.
3952
3953 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3954 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3955 Linker Scripts}.
3956
3957 @menu
3958 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3959 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3960 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3961 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3962 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3963 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3964 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3965 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3966 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3967 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3968 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3969 @end menu
3970
3971 @node Basic Script Concepts
3972 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3973 @cindex linker script concepts
3974 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3975 describe the linker script language.
3976
3977 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3978 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3979 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3980 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3981 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3982 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3983 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3984 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3985
3986 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3987 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3988 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3989 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3990 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3991 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3992 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3993 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3994 of debugging information.
3995
3996 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3997 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3998 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3999 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
4000 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
4001 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
4002 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
4003 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
4004 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
4005 RAM address would be the VMA.
4006
4007 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
4008 program with the @samp{-h} option.
4009
4010 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
4011 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
4012 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
4013 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
4014 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
4015 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
4016 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
4017
4018 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
4019 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
4020 option.
4021
4022 @node Script Format
4023 @section Linker Script Format
4024 @cindex linker script format
4025 Linker scripts are text files.
4026
4027 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
4028 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
4029 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
4030 generally ignored.
4031
4032 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
4033 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
4034 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
4035 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
4036 file name.
4037
4038 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
4039 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
4040 to whitespace.
4041
4042 @node Simple Example
4043 @section Simple Linker Script Example
4044 @cindex linker script example
4045 @cindex example of linker script
4046 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
4047
4048 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
4049 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
4050 memory layout of the output file.
4051
4052 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
4053 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
4054 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
4055 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
4056 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
4057 your input files.
4058
4059 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
4060 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
4061 linker script which will do that:
4062 @smallexample
4063 SECTIONS
4064 @{
4065 . = 0x10000;
4066 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4067 . = 0x8000000;
4068 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4069 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4070 @}
4071 @end smallexample
4072
4073 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4074 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4075 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4076
4077 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4078 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4079 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4080 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4081 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4082 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4083 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4084
4085 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4086 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4087 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4088 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4089 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4090 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4091
4092 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4093 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4094 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4095
4096 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4097 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4098 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4099 output section, the value of the location counter will be
4100 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4101 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
4102 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
4103
4104 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4105 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4106 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4107 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4108 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4109 sections.
4110
4111 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4112
4113 @node Simple Commands
4114 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
4115 @cindex linker script simple commands
4116 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4117
4118 @menu
4119 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4120 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4121 @ifclear SingleFormat
4122 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4123 @end ifclear
4124
4125 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
4126 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4127 @end menu
4128
4129 @node Entry Point
4130 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
4131 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4132 @cindex start of execution
4133 @cindex first instruction
4134 @cindex entry point
4135 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4136 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4137 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4138 @smallexample
4139 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4140 @end smallexample
4141
4142 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4143 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4144 stopping when one of them succeeds:
4145 @itemize @bullet
4146 @item
4147 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
4148 @item
4149 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
4150 @item
4151 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
4152 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
4153 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
4154 @item
4155 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4156 executable is being created - the code section is usually
4157 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
4158 @item
4159 The address @code{0}.
4160 @end itemize
4161
4162 @node File Commands
4163 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
4164 @cindex linker script file commands
4165 Several linker script commands deal with files.
4166
4167 @table @code
4168 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4169 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4170 @cindex including a linker script
4171 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4172 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
4173 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
4174 10 levels deep.
4175
4176 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4177 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4178
4179 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4180 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4181 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4182 @cindex input files in linker scripts
4183 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
4184 @cindex linker script input object files
4185 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4186 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4187
4188 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4189 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4190 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4191
4192 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4193 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4194
4195 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4196 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4197 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4198 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4199 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4200 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4201 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4202
4203 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4204 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4205 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4206 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4207 path.
4208
4209 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4210 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4211 @samp{-l}.
4212
4213 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4214 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4215 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4216
4217 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4218 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4219 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4220 @cindex grouping input files
4221 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4222 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4223 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4224 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4225
4226 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4227 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4228 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4229 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4230 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4231 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4232 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4233 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4234 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4235 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4236 setting afterwards.
4237
4238 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4239 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4240 @cindex output file name in linker script
4241 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4242 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4243 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4244 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4245 precedence.
4246
4247 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4248 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4249
4250 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4251 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4252 @cindex library search path in linker script
4253 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4254 @cindex search path in linker script
4255 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4256 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4257 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4258 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4259 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4260 the command-line option are searched first.
4261
4262 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4263 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4264 @cindex first input file
4265 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4266 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4267 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4268 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4269 first file.
4270 @end table
4271
4272 @ifclear SingleFormat
4273 @node Format Commands
4274 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4275 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4276
4277 @table @code
4278 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4279 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4280 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4281 @cindex output file format in linker script
4282 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4283 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4284 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4285 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4286 line option takes precedence.
4287
4288 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4289 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4290 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4291 desired endianness.
4292
4293 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4294 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4295 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4296 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4297
4298 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4299 command:
4300 @smallexample
4301 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4302 @end smallexample
4303 This says that the default format for the output file is
4304 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4305 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4306 format.
4307
4308 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4309 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4310 @cindex input file format in linker script
4311 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4312 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4313 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4314 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4315 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4316 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4317 @end table
4318 @end ifclear
4319
4320 @node REGION_ALIAS
4321 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4322 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4323 @cindex region alias
4324 @cindex region names
4325
4326 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4327 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4328
4329 @smallexample
4330 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4331 @end smallexample
4332
4333 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4334 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4335 to memory regions. An example follows.
4336
4337 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4338 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4339 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4340 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4341 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4342 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4343 sections:
4344
4345 @itemize @bullet
4346 @item
4347 @code{.text} program code;
4348 @item
4349 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4350 @item
4351 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4352 @item
4353 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4354 @end itemize
4355
4356 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4357 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4358 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4359 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4360 @code{C}:
4361 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4362 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4363 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4364 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4365 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4366 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4367 @end multitable
4368 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4369 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4370 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4371 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4372
4373 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4374 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4375 memory layout:
4376 @smallexample
4377 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4378
4379 SECTIONS
4380 @{
4381 .text :
4382 @{
4383 *(.text)
4384 @} > REGION_TEXT
4385 .rodata :
4386 @{
4387 *(.rodata)
4388 rodata_end = .;
4389 @} > REGION_RODATA
4390 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4391 @{
4392 data_start = .;
4393 *(.data)
4394 @} > REGION_DATA
4395 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4396 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4397 .bss :
4398 @{
4399 *(.bss)
4400 @} > REGION_BSS
4401 @}
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4405 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4406 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4407 @table @code
4408 @item A
4409 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4410 @smallexample
4411 MEMORY
4412 @{
4413 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4414 @}
4415
4416 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4417 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4418 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4419 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4420 @end smallexample
4421 @item B
4422 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4423 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4424 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4425 @smallexample
4426 MEMORY
4427 @{
4428 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4429 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4430 @}
4431
4432 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4433 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4434 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4435 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4436 @end smallexample
4437 @item C
4438 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4439 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4440 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4441 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4442 @smallexample
4443 MEMORY
4444 @{
4445 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4446 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4447 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4448 @}
4449
4450 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4451 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4452 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4453 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4454 @end smallexample
4455 @end table
4456
4457 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4458 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4459 necessary:
4460 @smallexample
4461 #include <string.h>
4462
4463 extern char data_start [];
4464 extern char data_size [];
4465 extern char data_load_start [];
4466
4467 void copy_data(void)
4468 @{
4469 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4470 @{
4471 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4472 @}
4473 @}
4474 @end smallexample
4475
4476 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4477 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4478 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4479
4480 @table @code
4481 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4482 @kindex ASSERT
4483 @cindex assertion in linker script
4484 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4485 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4486
4487 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4488 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4489 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4490 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4491 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4492
4493 @smallexample
4494 .stack :
4495 @{
4496 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4497 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4498 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4499 @}
4500 @end smallexample
4501
4502 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4503 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4504 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4508 .stack :
4509 @{
4510 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4511 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4512 @}
4513 @end smallexample
4514
4515 will work.
4516
4517 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4518 @kindex EXTERN
4519 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4520 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4521 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4522 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4523 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4524 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4525
4526 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4527 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4528 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4529 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4530 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4531 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4532
4533 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4534 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4535 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4536 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4537 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4538 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4539
4540 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4541 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4542 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4543 @cindex section groups
4544 @cindex COMDAT
4545 This command has the same effect as the
4546 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4547 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4548 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4549 specified (@samp{-r}).
4550
4551 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4552 @kindex INSERT
4553 @cindex insert user script into default script
4554 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4555 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4556 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4557 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4558 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4559 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4560 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4561 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4562 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4563 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4564 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4565 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4566 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4567
4568 @smallexample
4569 SECTIONS
4570 @{
4571 OVERLAY :
4572 @{
4573 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4574 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4575 @}
4576 @}
4577 INSERT AFTER .text;
4578 @end smallexample
4579
4580 Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4581 script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4582 of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4583 The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4584 command line.
4585
4586 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4587 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4588 @cindex cross references
4589 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4590 references among certain output sections.
4591
4592 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4593 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4594 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4595 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4596 a function defined in the other section.
4597
4598 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4599 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4600 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4601 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4602 names.
4603
4604 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4605 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4606 @cindex cross references
4607 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4608 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4609
4610 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4611 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4612 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4613 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4614 must never call back.
4615
4616 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4617 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4618 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4619 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4620 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4621 names, not input section names.
4622
4623 @ifclear SingleFormat
4624 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4625 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4626 @cindex machine architecture
4627 @cindex architecture
4628 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4629 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4630 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4631 the @samp{-f} option.
4632 @end ifclear
4633
4634 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4635 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4636 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4637 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4638 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4639 @xref{Expression Section}.
4640 @end table
4641
4642 @node Assignments
4643 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4644 @cindex assignment in scripts
4645 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4646 @cindex variables, defining
4647 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4648 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4649
4650 @menu
4651 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4652 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4653 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4654 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4655 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4656 @end menu
4657
4658 @node Simple Assignments
4659 @subsection Simple Assignments
4660
4661 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4662
4663 @table @code
4664 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4665 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4666 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4667 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4668 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4669 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4670 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4671 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4672 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4673 @end table
4674
4675 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4676 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4677 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4678
4679 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4680 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4681
4682 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4683
4684 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4685
4686 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4687 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4688 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4689
4690 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4691 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4692
4693 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4694 assignments may be used:
4695
4696 @smallexample
4697 floating_point = 0;
4698 SECTIONS
4699 @{
4700 .text :
4701 @{
4702 *(.text)
4703 _etext = .;
4704 @}
4705 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4706 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4707 @}
4708 @end smallexample
4709 @noindent
4710 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4711 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4712 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4713 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4714 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4715
4716 @node HIDDEN
4717 @subsection HIDDEN
4718 @cindex HIDDEN
4719 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4720 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4721
4722 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4723 @code{HIDDEN}:
4724
4725 @smallexample
4726 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4727 SECTIONS
4728 @{
4729 .text :
4730 @{
4731 *(.text)
4732 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4733 @}
4734 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4735 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4736 @}
4737 @end smallexample
4738 @noindent
4739 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4740
4741 @node PROVIDE
4742 @subsection PROVIDE
4743 @cindex PROVIDE
4744 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4745 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4746 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4747 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4748 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4749 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4750 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4751 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4752
4753 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4754 @smallexample
4755 SECTIONS
4756 @{
4757 .text :
4758 @{
4759 *(.text)
4760 _etext = .;
4761 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4762 @}
4763 @}
4764 @end smallexample
4765
4766 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4767 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4768 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4769 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4770 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4771 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4772
4773 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4774 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4775 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4776 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4777 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4778
4779 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4780 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4781 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4782 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4783 hidden and won't be exported.
4784
4785 @node Source Code Reference
4786 @subsection Source Code Reference
4787
4788 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4789 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4790 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4791 symbol that does not have a value.
4792
4793 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4794 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4795 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4796 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4797 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4798 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4799 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4800 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4801
4802 @smallexample
4803 extern int foo;
4804 @end smallexample
4805
4806 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 _foo = 1000;
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4813 transformation has taken place.
4814
4815 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4816 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4817 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4818 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4819 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4820 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4821 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4822
4823 @smallexample
4824 int foo = 1000;
4825 @end smallexample
4826
4827 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4828 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4829 number 1000 is initially stored.
4830
4831 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4832 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4833 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4834 So:
4835
4836 @smallexample
4837 foo = 1;
4838 @end smallexample
4839
4840 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4841 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4842 address. Whereas:
4843
4844 @smallexample
4845 int * a = & foo;
4846 @end smallexample
4847
4848 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4849 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4850 the variable @samp{a}.
4851
4852 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4853 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4854 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4855
4856 @smallexample
4857 foo = 1000;
4858 @end smallexample
4859
4860 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4861 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4862 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4863 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4864 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4865
4866 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4867 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4868 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4869 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4870 linker script contains these declarations:
4871
4872 @smallexample
4873 @group
4874 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4875 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4876 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4877 @end group
4878 @end smallexample
4879
4880 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4881
4882 @smallexample
4883 @group
4884 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4885
4886 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4887 @end group
4888 @end smallexample
4889
4890 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4891 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4892 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4893
4894 @smallexample
4895 @group
4896 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4897
4898 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4899 @end group
4900 @end smallexample
4901
4902 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4903 operators.
4904
4905 @node SECTIONS
4906 @section SECTIONS Command
4907 @kindex SECTIONS
4908 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4909 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4910
4911 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4912 @smallexample
4913 SECTIONS
4914 @{
4915 @var{sections-command}
4916 @var{sections-command}
4917 @dots{}
4918 @}
4919 @end smallexample
4920
4921 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4922
4923 @itemize @bullet
4924 @item
4925 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4926 @item
4927 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4928 @item
4929 an output section description
4930 @item
4931 an overlay description
4932 @end itemize
4933
4934 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4935 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4936 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4937 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4938 the layout of the output file.
4939
4940 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4941 below.
4942
4943 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4944 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4945 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4946 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4947 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4948 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4949
4950 @menu
4951 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4952 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4953 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4954 * Input Section:: Input section description
4955 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4956 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4957 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4958 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4959 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4960 @end menu
4961
4962 @node Output Section Description
4963 @subsection Output Section Description
4964 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4965 @smallexample
4966 @group
4967 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4968 [AT(@var{lma})]
4969 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4970 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4971 [@var{constraint}]
4972 @{
4973 @var{output-section-command}
4974 @var{output-section-command}
4975 @dots{}
4976 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4977 @end group
4978 @end smallexample
4979
4980 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4981
4982 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4983 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4984 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4985 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4986 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4987
4988 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4989
4990 @itemize @bullet
4991 @item
4992 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4993 @item
4994 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4995 @item
4996 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4997 @item
4998 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4999 @end itemize
5000
5001 @node Output Section Name
5002 @subsection Output Section Name
5003 @cindex name, section
5004 @cindex section name
5005 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
5006 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
5007 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
5008 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
5009 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
5010 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
5011 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
5012 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
5013 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
5014 commas must be quoted.
5015
5016 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
5017 Discarding}.
5018
5019 @node Output Section Address
5020 @subsection Output Section Address
5021 @cindex address, section
5022 @cindex section address
5023 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
5024 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
5025 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
5026
5027 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
5028 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
5029 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
5030 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
5031 contained within the output section.
5032
5033 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
5034
5035 @itemize @bullet
5036 @item
5037 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
5038 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
5039 in that region.
5040
5041 @item
5042 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
5043 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
5044 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
5045 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
5046
5047 @item
5048 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
5049 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
5050 counter.
5051 @end itemize
5052
5053 @noindent
5054 For example:
5055
5056 @smallexample
5057 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
5058 @end smallexample
5059
5060 @noindent
5061 and
5062
5063 @smallexample
5064 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5065 @end smallexample
5066
5067 @noindent
5068 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5069 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5070 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
5071 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5072 input sections.
5073
5074 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5075 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5076 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5077 do something like this:
5078 @smallexample
5079 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5080 @end smallexample
5081 @noindent
5082 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5083 aligned upward to the specified value.
5084
5085 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
5086 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5087 sections are ignored).
5088
5089 @node Input Section
5090 @subsection Input Section Description
5091 @cindex input sections
5092 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5093 The most common output section command is an input section description.
5094
5095 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5096 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5097 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5098 map the input files into your memory layout.
5099
5100 @menu
5101 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5102 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5103 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5104 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5105 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
5106 @end menu
5107
5108 @node Input Section Basics
5109 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
5110 @cindex input section basics
5111 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5112 by a list of section names in parentheses.
5113
5114 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5115 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5116
5117 The most common input section description is to include all input
5118 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5119 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5120 @smallexample
5121 *(.text)
5122 @end smallexample
5123 @noindent
5124 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
5125 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
5126 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5127 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5128 example:
5129 @smallexample
5130 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5131 @end smallexample
5132 @noindent
5133 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5134 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5135 placed inside the section list, for example:
5136 @smallexample
5137 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
5138 @end smallexample
5139 @noindent
5140 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5141 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5142 more than one section, as described below.
5143
5144 There are two ways to include more than one section:
5145 @smallexample
5146 *(.text .rdata)
5147 *(.text) *(.rdata)
5148 @end smallexample
5149 @noindent
5150 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5151 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
5152 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5153 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
5154 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5155 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
5156
5157 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5158 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5159 immediately following section, for example:
5160 @smallexample
5161 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5162 @end smallexample
5163 @noindent
5164 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5165 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5166 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5167 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
5168 could be modified to:
5169 @smallexample
5170 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5171 @end smallexample
5172 @noindent
5173 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5174 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5175 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5176 @smallexample
5177 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5178 @end smallexample
5179
5180 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5181 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5182 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5183 @smallexample
5184 data.o(.data)
5185 @end smallexample
5186
5187 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5188 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5189
5190 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5191
5192 @smallexample
5193 @group
5194 SECTIONS @{
5195 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5196 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5197 @}
5198 @end group
5199 @end smallexample
5200
5201 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5202 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5203 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5204 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5205 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5206
5207 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5208 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5209 with no whitespace around the colon.
5210
5211 @table @samp
5212 @item archive:file
5213 matches file within archive
5214 @item archive:
5215 matches the whole archive
5216 @item :file
5217 matches file but not one in an archive
5218 @end table
5219
5220 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5221 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5222 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5223 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5224 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5225 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5226 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5227 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5228 command.
5229
5230 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5231 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5232 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5233 @smallexample
5234 data.o
5235 @end smallexample
5236
5237 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5238 and does not contain any wild card
5239 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5240 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5241 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5242 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5243 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5244 the archive search path.
5245
5246 @node Input Section Wildcards
5247 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5248 @cindex input section wildcards
5249 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5250 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5251 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5252 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5253 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5254
5255 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5256 pattern for the file name.
5257
5258 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5259
5260 @table @samp
5261 @item *
5262 matches any number of characters
5263 @item ?
5264 matches any single character
5265 @item [@var{chars}]
5266 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5267 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5268 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5269 @item \
5270 quotes the following character
5271 @end table
5272
5273 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5274 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5275 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5276
5277 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5278 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5279 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5280 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5281 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5282 @smallexample
5283 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5284 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5285 @end smallexample
5286
5287 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5288 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5289 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5290 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5291 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5292 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5293 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5294
5295 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5296 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5297 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5298 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5299 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5300 needed.
5301
5302 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5303 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5304 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5305 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5306 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5307 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5308 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5309 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5310
5311 @cindex SORT
5312 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5313
5314 @cindex REVERSE
5315 @code{REVERSE} indicates that the sorting should be reversed. If used
5316 on its own then @code{REVERSE} implies @code{SORT_BY_NAME}, otherwise
5317 it reverses the enclosed @code{SORT..} command. Note - reverse
5318 sorting of alignment is not currently supported.
5319
5320 Note - the sorting commands only accept a single wildcard pattern. So
5321 for example the following will not work:
5322 @smallexample
5323 *(REVERSE(.text* .init*))
5324 @end smallexample
5325 To resolve this problem list the patterns individually, like this:
5326 @smallexample
5327 *(REVERSE(.text*))
5328 *(REVERSE(.init*))
5329 @end smallexample
5330
5331 Note - you can put the @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} command inside a sorting
5332 command, but not the other way around. So for example:
5333 @smallexample
5334 *(SORT_BY_NAME(EXCLUDE_FILE(foo) .text*))
5335 @end smallexample
5336 will work, but:
5337 @smallexample
5338 *(EXCLUDE_FILE(foo) SORT_BY_NAME(.text*))
5339 @end smallexample
5340 will not.
5341
5342
5343 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5344 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5345
5346 @enumerate
5347 @item
5348 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5349 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5350 sections have the same name.
5351 @item
5352 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5353 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5354 sections have the same alignment.
5355 @item
5356 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5357 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5358 @item
5359 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5360 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5361 @item
5362 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{REVERSE} (wildcard section pattern))
5363 reverse sorts by name.
5364 @item
5365 @code{REVERSE} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern))
5366 reverse sorts by name.
5367 @item
5368 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} (@code{REVERSE} (wildcard section pattern))
5369 reverse sorts by init priority.
5370 @item
5371 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5372 @end enumerate
5373
5374 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5375 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5376 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5377
5378 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5379 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5380 treated as nested sorting command.
5381
5382 @enumerate
5383 @item
5384 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5385 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5386 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5387 @item
5388 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5389 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5390 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5391 @end enumerate
5392
5393 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5394 command-line option will be ignored.
5395
5396 @cindex SORT_NONE
5397 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5398 section sorting option.
5399
5400 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5401 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5402 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5403
5404 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5405 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5406 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5407 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5408 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5409 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5410 @smallexample
5411 @group
5412 SECTIONS @{
5413 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5414 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5415 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5416 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5417 @}
5418 @end group
5419 @end smallexample
5420
5421 @node Input Section Common
5422 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5423 @cindex common symbol placement
5424 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5425 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5426 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5427 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5428 named @samp{COMMON}.
5429
5430 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5431 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5432 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5433 input files are placed in another section.
5434
5435 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5436 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5437 @smallexample
5438 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5439 @end smallexample
5440
5441 @cindex scommon section
5442 @cindex small common symbols
5443 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5444 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5445 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5446 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5447 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5448 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5449 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5450 locations.
5451
5452 @cindex [COMMON]
5453 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5454 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5455 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5456
5457 @node Input Section Keep
5458 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5459 @cindex KEEP
5460 @cindex garbage collection
5461 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5462 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5463 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5464 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5465 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5466
5467 @node Input Section Example
5468 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5469 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5470 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5471 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5472 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5473 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5474 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5475 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5476 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5477 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5478
5479 @smallexample
5480 @group
5481 SECTIONS @{
5482 outputa 0x10000 :
5483 @{
5484 all.o
5485 foo.o (.input1)
5486 @}
5487 @end group
5488 @group
5489 outputb :
5490 @{
5491 foo.o (.input2)
5492 foo1.o (.input1)
5493 @}
5494 @end group
5495 @group
5496 outputc :
5497 @{
5498 *(.input1)
5499 *(.input2)
5500 @}
5501 @}
5502 @end group
5503 @end smallexample
5504
5505 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5506 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5507 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5508 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5509 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5510 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5511 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5512
5513 @node Output Section Data
5514 @subsection Output Section Data
5515 @cindex data
5516 @cindex section data
5517 @cindex output section data
5518 @kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
5519 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5520 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5521 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5522 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5523 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5524 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5525 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5526 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5527 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5528 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5529 counter.
5530
5531 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5532 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5533 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5534 stored.
5535
5536 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5537 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5538 @smallexample
5539 BYTE(1)
5540 LONG(addr)
5541 @end smallexample
5542
5543 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5544 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5545 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5546 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5547 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5548
5549 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5550 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5551 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5552 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5553 endianness of the first input object file.
5554
5555 You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5556 @code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5557 the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5558 end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5559 quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5560 Hex numbers are not supported.
5561
5562 For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5563 @smallexample
5564 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5565 @end smallexample
5566
5567 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5568 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5569 @smallexample
5570 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5571 @end smallexample
5572 whereas this will work:
5573 @smallexample
5574 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5578 @cindex holes, filling
5579 @cindex unspecified memory
5580 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5581 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5582 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5583 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5584 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5585 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5586 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5587 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5588 different parts of an output section.
5589
5590 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5591 value @samp{0x90}:
5592 @smallexample
5593 FILL(0x90909090)
5594 @end smallexample
5595
5596 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5597 section attribute, but it only affects the
5598 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5599 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5600 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5601 expression.
5602
5603 Note - normally the value of @code{expression} is zero extended to 4
5604 bytes when used to fill gaps. Thus @samp{FILL(144)} will fill a
5605 region with repeats of the pattern @samp{0 0 0 144}. The value is
5606 treated as a big-endian number, so for example
5607 @samp{FILL(22 * 256 + 23)} will fill the region with repeats of the
5608 pattern @samp {0 0 22 23}. If the expression results in a value with
5609 more than 4 significant bytes only the least 4 bytes of the value will
5610 be used.
5611
5612 The above rules do not apply when the @code{expression} is a simple
5613 hexadecimal number. In this case zero extension is not performed and
5614 all bytes are significant. So @samp{FILL(0x90)} will fill a region with
5615 repeats of @samp{0x90} with no zero bytes, and @samp{FILL(0x9192)}
5616 will fill the region with repeats of @samp{0x91 0x92}. Zero bytes
5617 in a hexadecimal expression are significant even at the start, so
5618 @samp{FILL(0x0090)} will fill a region with repeats of @samp{0x00 0x90}.
5619
5620 Hexadecimal numbers can be longer than 4 bytes, and all of the bytes
5621 are significant, so @samp{FILL(0x123456789a)} will fill a region with
5622 repeats of the 5 byte sequence @samp{0x12 0x34 0x56 0x78 0x9a}.
5623 Excess bytes in a hexadecimal value beyond the size of a region will
5624 be silently ignored.
5625
5626 The above only applies to hexadecimal numbers specified as
5627 @samp{0x[0-9][a-f][A-F]}. Hexadecimal numbers specified with a
5628 @samp{$} prefix, or a @samp{h}, @samp{H}, @samp{x} or @samp{X} suffix
5629 will follow the normal fill value rules. This also applies to
5630 expressions that involve hexadecimal numbers, and hexadecimal numbers
5631 that have a magnitude suffix.
5632
5633 @kindex LINKER_VERSION
5634 @cindex LINKER_VERSION
5635 The @code{LINKER_VERSION} command inserts a string containing the
5636 version of the linker at the current point. Note - by default this
5637 directive is disabled and will do nothing. It only becomes active if
5638 the @option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
5639
5640 Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5641 directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5642
5643 @node Output Section Keywords
5644 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5645 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5646 commands.
5647
5648 @table @code
5649 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5650 @cindex input filename symbols
5651 @cindex filename symbols
5652 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5653 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5654 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5655 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5656 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5657
5658 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5659 normally used for any other object file format.
5660
5661 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5662 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5663 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5664 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5665 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5666 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5667 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5668 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5669 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5670 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5671 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5672 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5673 ignored for other object file formats.
5674
5675 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5676 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5677 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5678 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5679 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5680 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5681 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5682 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5683 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5684 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5685 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5686 @code{exit}.
5687
5688 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5689 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5690 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5691 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5692 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5693 runtime code expects to see.
5694
5695 @smallexample
5696 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5697 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5698 *(.ctors)
5699 LONG(0)
5700 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5701 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5702 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5703 *(.dtors)
5704 LONG(0)
5705 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5706 @end smallexample
5707
5708 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5709 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5710 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5711 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5712 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5713 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5714 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5715 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5716
5717 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5718 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5719 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5720 scripts.
5721
5722 @end table
5723
5724 @node Output Section Discarding
5725 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5726 @cindex discarding sections
5727 @cindex sections, discarding
5728 @cindex removing sections
5729 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5730 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5731 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5732 @smallexample
5733 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5734 @end smallexample
5735 @noindent
5736 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5737 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5738 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5739 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5740 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5741 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5742 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5743 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5744 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5745
5746 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5747 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5748 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5749 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5750 section is discarded.
5751
5752 @cindex /DISCARD/
5753 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5754 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5755 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5756
5757 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5758 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5759 garbage collection.
5760
5761 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5762 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5763 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5764 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5765
5766 @node Output Section Attributes
5767 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5768 @cindex output section attributes
5769 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5770 like this:
5771
5772 @smallexample
5773 @group
5774 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5775 [AT(@var{lma})]
5776 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5777 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5778 [@var{constraint}]
5779 @{
5780 @var{output-section-command}
5781 @var{output-section-command}
5782 @dots{}
5783 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5784 @end group
5785 @end smallexample
5786
5787 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5788 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5789 remaining section attributes.
5790
5791 @menu
5792 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5793 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5794 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5795 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5796 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5797 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5798 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5799 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5800 @end menu
5801
5802 @node Output Section Type
5803 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5804 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5805 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5806
5807 @table @code
5808
5809 @item NOLOAD
5810 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5811 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5812
5813 @item READONLY
5814 The section should be marked as read-only.
5815
5816 @item DSECT
5817 @item COPY
5818 @item INFO
5819 @item OVERLAY
5820 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5821 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5822 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5823 section when the program is run.
5824
5825 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5826 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5827 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5828 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5829 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5830 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5831 special requirements of the section type are met.
5832
5833 Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5834 section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5835 @smallexample
5836 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5837 @end smallexample
5838 will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5839 @samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5840 type. Whereas:
5841 @smallexample
5842 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5843 @end smallexample
5844 will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5845 to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5846 type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5847 @smallexample
5848 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5849 @end smallexample
5850
5851 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5852 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5853 type specified by @var{type}.
5854
5855 @end table
5856
5857 @kindex NOLOAD
5858 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5859 @cindex loading, preventing
5860 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5861 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5862 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5863 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5864 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5865 @smallexample
5866 @group
5867 SECTIONS @{
5868 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5869 @dots{}
5870 @}
5871 @end group
5872 @end smallexample
5873
5874 @node Output Section LMA
5875 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5876 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5877 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5878 @cindex load address
5879 @cindex section load address
5880 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5881 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5882 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5883 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5884 address is optional.
5885
5886 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5887 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5888 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5889 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5890 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5891
5892 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5893 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5894 load address:
5895
5896 @itemize @bullet
5897 @item
5898 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5899 the LMA address as well.
5900
5901 @item
5902 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5903
5904 @item
5905 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5906 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5907 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5908 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5909 the last section in the located region.
5910
5911 @item
5912 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5913 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5914
5915 @item
5916 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5917 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5918 @end itemize
5919
5920 @cindex ROM initialized data
5921 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5922 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5923 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5924 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5925 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5926 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5927 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5928 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5929 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5930
5931 @smallexample
5932 @group
5933 SECTIONS
5934 @{
5935 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5936 .mdata 0x2000 :
5937 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5938 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5939 .bss 0x3000 :
5940 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5941 @}
5942 @end group
5943 @end smallexample
5944
5945 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5946 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5947 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5948 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5949 script.
5950
5951 @smallexample
5952 @group
5953 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5954 char *src = &_etext;
5955 char *dst = &_data;
5956
5957 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5958 while (dst < &_edata)
5959 *dst++ = *src++;
5960
5961 /* Zero bss. */
5962 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5963 *dst = 0;
5964 @end group
5965 @end smallexample
5966
5967 @node Forced Output Alignment
5968 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5969 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5970 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5971 @cindex output section alignment
5972 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5973 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5974 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5975
5976 @node Forced Input Alignment
5977 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5978 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5979 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5980 @cindex input section alignment
5981 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5982 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5983 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5984
5985 @node Output Section Constraint
5986 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5987 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5988 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5989 @cindex constraints on output sections
5990 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5991 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5992 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5993 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5994
5995 @node Output Section Region
5996 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5997 @kindex >@var{region}
5998 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5999 @cindex memory regions and sections
6000 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
6001 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
6002
6003 Here is a simple example:
6004 @smallexample
6005 @group
6006 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
6007 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
6008 @end group
6009 @end smallexample
6010
6011 @node Output Section Phdr
6012 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
6013 @kindex :@var{phdr}
6014 @cindex section, assigning to program header
6015 @cindex program headers and sections
6016 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
6017 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
6018 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
6019 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
6020 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
6021 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
6022
6023 Here is a simple example:
6024 @smallexample
6025 @group
6026 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
6027 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
6028 @end group
6029 @end smallexample
6030
6031 @node Output Section Fill
6032 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
6033 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
6034 @cindex section fill pattern
6035 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
6036 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
6037 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
6038 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
6039 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
6040 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
6041 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
6042 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
6043 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
6044 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
6045 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
6046 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
6047 expression. If the value is less than four bytes in size then it will
6048 be zero extended to four bytes. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 Fill Value Fill Pattern
6052 0x90 90 90 90 90
6053 0x0090 00 90 00 90
6054 144 00 00 00 90
6055 @end smallexample
6056
6057 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
6058 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
6059
6060 Here is a simple example:
6061 @smallexample
6062 @group
6063 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
6064 @end group
6065 @end smallexample
6066
6067 @node Overlay Description
6068 @subsection Overlay Description
6069 @kindex OVERLAY
6070 @cindex overlays
6071 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
6072 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
6073 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
6074 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
6075 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
6076 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
6077 than another.
6078
6079 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
6080 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
6081 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
6082 command is as follows:
6083 @smallexample
6084 @group
6085 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
6086 @{
6087 @var{secname1}
6088 @{
6089 @var{output-section-command}
6090 @var{output-section-command}
6091 @dots{}
6092 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
6093 @var{secname2}
6094 @{
6095 @var{output-section-command}
6096 @var{output-section-command}
6097 @dots{}
6098 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
6099 @dots{}
6100 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
6101 @end group
6102 @end smallexample
6103
6104 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
6105 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
6106 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
6107 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
6108 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
6109 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
6110
6111 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
6112 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
6113
6114 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
6115 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
6116 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
6117 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
6118 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
6119 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
6120
6121 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
6122 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
6123 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
6124 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
6125 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
6126
6127 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
6128 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
6129 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
6130 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
6131 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
6132 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
6133 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
6134
6135 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
6136 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
6137
6138 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
6139 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
6140 @smallexample
6141 @group
6142 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6143 @{
6144 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6145 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6146 @}
6147 @end group
6148 @end smallexample
6149 @noindent
6150 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6151 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6152 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
6153 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
6154 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6155 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
6156
6157 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6158 like the following.
6159
6160 @smallexample
6161 @group
6162 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6163 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6164 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6165 @end group
6166 @end smallexample
6167
6168 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6169 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6170 example could have been written identically as follows.
6171
6172 @smallexample
6173 @group
6174 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6175 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6176 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
6177 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6178 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6179 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
6180 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6181 @end group
6182 @end smallexample
6183
6184 @node MEMORY
6185 @section MEMORY Command
6186 @kindex MEMORY
6187 @cindex memory regions
6188 @cindex regions of memory
6189 @cindex allocating memory
6190 @cindex discontinuous memory
6191 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6192 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6193
6194 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6195 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6196 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6197 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6198 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6199 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6200 around to fit into the available regions.
6201
6202 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6203 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6204 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6205 @code{MEMORY} is:
6206 @smallexample
6207 @group
6208 MEMORY
6209 @{
6210 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6211 @dots{}
6212 @}
6213 @end group
6214 @end smallexample
6215
6216 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6217 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6218 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6219 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
6220 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6221 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
6222 command.
6223
6224 @cindex memory region attributes
6225 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6226 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6227 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6228 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6229 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6230 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6231 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6232
6233 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6234 @table @samp
6235 @item R
6236 Read-only section
6237 @item W
6238 Read/write section
6239 @item X
6240 Executable section
6241 @item A
6242 Allocatable section
6243 @item I
6244 Initialized section
6245 @item L
6246 Same as @samp{I}
6247 @item !
6248 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
6249 @end table
6250
6251 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
6252 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
6253 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6254 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6255 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6256 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6257 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6258 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
6259
6260 @kindex ORIGIN =
6261 @kindex o =
6262 @kindex org =
6263 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6264 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6265 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6266 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6267 @code{ORG}).
6268
6269 @kindex LENGTH =
6270 @kindex len =
6271 @kindex l =
6272 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6273 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
6274 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6275 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
6276
6277 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6278 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6279 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6280 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6281 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6282 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6283 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6284 region.
6285
6286 @smallexample
6287 @group
6288 MEMORY
6289 @{
6290 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6291 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6292 @}
6293 @end group
6294 @end smallexample
6295
6296 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6297 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6298 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6299 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6300 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6301 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6302 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6303 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6304 region, the linker will issue an error message.
6305
6306 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
6307 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
6308 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6309
6310 @smallexample
6311 @group
6312 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
6313 @end group
6314 @end smallexample
6315
6316 @node PHDRS
6317 @section PHDRS Command
6318 @kindex PHDRS
6319 @cindex program headers
6320 @cindex ELF program headers
6321 @cindex program segments
6322 @cindex segments, ELF
6323 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6324 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6325 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6326 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6327
6328 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6329 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6330 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6331 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6332 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6333
6334 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6335 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6336 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6337 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6338 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6339
6340 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6341 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6342 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6343
6344 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6345 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6346
6347 @smallexample
6348 @group
6349 PHDRS
6350 @{
6351 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6352 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6353 @}
6354 @end group
6355 @end smallexample
6356
6357 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6358 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6359 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6360 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6361 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6362 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6363
6364 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6365 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6366 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6367 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6368 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6369 Section Phdr}.
6370
6371 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6372 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6373 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6374 contain the section.
6375
6376 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6377 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6378 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6379 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6380 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6381 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6382 segment at all.
6383
6384 @kindex FILEHDR
6385 @kindex PHDRS
6386 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6387 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6388 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6389 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6390 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6391 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6392 these keywords.
6393
6394 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6395 value of the keyword.
6396
6397 @table @asis
6398 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6399 Indicates an unused program header.
6400
6401 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6402 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6403 the file.
6404
6405 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6406 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6407
6408 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6409 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6410 found.
6411
6412 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6413 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6414
6415 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6416 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6417 ABI.
6418
6419 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6420 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6421
6422 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6423 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6424
6425 @item @var{expression}
6426 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6427 be used for types not defined above.
6428 @end table
6429
6430 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6431 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6432 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6433 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6434 output section attribute.
6435
6436 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6437 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6438 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6439 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6440 header.
6441
6442 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6443 headers used on a native ELF system.
6444
6445 @example
6446 @group
6447 PHDRS
6448 @{
6449 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6450 interp PT_INTERP ;
6451 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6452 data PT_LOAD ;
6453 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6454 @}
6455
6456 SECTIONS
6457 @{
6458 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6459 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6460 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6461 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6462 @dots{}
6463 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6464 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6465 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6466 @dots{}
6467 @}
6468 @end group
6469 @end example
6470
6471 @node VERSION
6472 @section VERSION Command
6473 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6474 @cindex symbol versions
6475 @cindex version script
6476 @cindex versions of symbols
6477 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6478 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6479 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6480 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6481 shared library.
6482
6483 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6484 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6485 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6486
6487 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6488 @smallexample
6489 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6490 @end smallexample
6491
6492 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6493 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6494 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6495 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6496 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6497 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6498 library.
6499
6500 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6501 examples.
6502
6503 @smallexample
6504 VERS_1.1 @{
6505 global:
6506 foo1;
6507 local:
6508 old*;
6509 original*;
6510 new*;
6511 @};
6512
6513 VERS_1.2 @{
6514 foo2;
6515 @} VERS_1.1;
6516
6517 VERS_2.0 @{
6518 bar1; bar2;
6519 extern "C++" @{
6520 ns::*;
6521 "f(int, double)";
6522 @};
6523 @} VERS_1.2;
6524 @end smallexample
6525
6526 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6527 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6528 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6529 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6530 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6531 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6532 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6533 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6534 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6535 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6536
6537 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6538 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6539 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6540
6541 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6542 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6543 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6544
6545 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6546 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6547 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6548 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6549 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6550 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6551 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6552 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6553 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6554
6555 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6556 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6557 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6558 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6559
6560 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6561 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6562 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6563 won't.
6564
6565 @smallexample
6566 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6567 @end smallexample
6568
6569 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6570 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6571 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6572 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6573 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6574 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6575 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6576 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6577 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6578 search for each symbol reference.
6579
6580 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6581 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6582 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6583 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6584 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6585 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6586 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6587 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6588 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6589
6590 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6591 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6592 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6593 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6594 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6595 @smallexample
6596 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6597 @end smallexample
6598 @noindent
6599 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6600 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6601 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6602 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6603 takes precedence over a version script.
6604
6605 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6606 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6607 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6608 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6609 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6610
6611 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6612 source file. Here is an example:
6613
6614 @smallexample
6615 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6616 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6617 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6618 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6619 @end smallexample
6620
6621 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6622 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6623 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6624 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6625
6626 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6627 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6628 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6629 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6630 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6631 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6632
6633 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6634 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6635 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6636 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6637
6638 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6639
6640 @smallexample
6641 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6642 @end smallexample
6643
6644 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6645 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6646 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6647 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6648 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6649
6650 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6651 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6652 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6653 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6654 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6655 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6656 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6657 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6658 expect when you upgrade.
6659
6660 @node Expressions
6661 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6662 @cindex expressions
6663 @cindex arithmetic
6664 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6665 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6666 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6667 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6668 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6669 otherwise 64 bits.
6670
6671 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6672
6673 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6674 expressions.
6675
6676 @menu
6677 * Constants:: Constants
6678 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6679 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6680 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6681 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6682 * Operators:: Operators
6683 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6684 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6685 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6686 @end menu
6687
6688 @node Constants
6689 @subsection Constants
6690 @cindex integer notation
6691 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6692 All constants are integers.
6693
6694 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6695 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6696 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6697 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6698 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6699 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6700
6701 @cindex scaled integers
6702 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6703 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6704 @cindex suffixes for integers
6705 @cindex integer suffixes
6706 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6707 constant by
6708 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6709 @ifnottex
6710 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6711 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6712 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6713 @end ifnottex
6714 @tex
6715 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6716 @end tex
6717 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6718 respectively. For example, the following
6719 all refer to the same quantity:
6720
6721 @smallexample
6722 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6723 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6724 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6725 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6726 @end smallexample
6727
6728 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6729 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6730
6731 @node Symbolic Constants
6732 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6733 @cindex symbolic constants
6734 @kindex CONSTANT
6735 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6736 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6737
6738 @table @code
6739 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6740 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6741 The target's maximum page size.
6742
6743 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6744 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6745 The target's default page size.
6746 @end table
6747
6748 So for example:
6749
6750 @smallexample
6751 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6752 @end smallexample
6753
6754 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6755 supported by the target.
6756
6757 @node Symbols
6758 @subsection Symbol Names
6759 @cindex symbol names
6760 @cindex names
6761 @cindex quoted symbol names
6762 @kindex "
6763 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6764 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6765 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6766 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6767 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6768 @smallexample
6769 "SECTION" = 9;
6770 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6771 @end smallexample
6772
6773 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6774 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6775 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6776
6777 @node Orphan Sections
6778 @subsection Orphan Sections
6779 @cindex orphan
6780 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6781 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6782 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6783 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6784 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6785
6786 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6787 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6788 placed at the end of that output section.
6789
6790 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6791 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6792 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6793 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6794 one new output section.
6795
6796 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6797 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6798 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6799 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6800 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6801 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6802 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6803
6804 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6805 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6806 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6807
6808 @node Location Counter
6809 @subsection The Location Counter
6810 @kindex .
6811 @cindex dot
6812 @cindex location counter
6813 @cindex current output location
6814 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6815 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6816 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6817 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6818 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6819
6820 @cindex holes
6821 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6822 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6823 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6824 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6825 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6826
6827 @smallexample
6828 SECTIONS
6829 @{
6830 output :
6831 @{
6832 file1(.text)
6833 . = . + 1000;
6834 file2(.text)
6835 . += 1000;
6836 file3(.text)
6837 @} = 0x12345678;
6838 @}
6839 @end smallexample
6840 @noindent
6841 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6842 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6843 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6844 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6845 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6846 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6847
6848 @cindex dot inside sections
6849 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6850 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6851 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6852 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6853 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6854 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6855
6856 @smallexample
6857 SECTIONS
6858 @{
6859 . = 0x100
6860 .text: @{
6861 *(.text)
6862 . = 0x200
6863 @}
6864 . = 0x500
6865 .data: @{
6866 *(.data)
6867 . += 0x600
6868 @}
6869 @}
6870 @end smallexample
6871
6872 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6873 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6874 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6875 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6876 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6877 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6878 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6879 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6880
6881 @cindex dot outside sections
6882 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6883 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6884 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6885
6886 @smallexample
6887 SECTIONS
6888 @{
6889 start_of_text = . ;
6890 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6891 end_of_text = . ;
6892
6893 start_of_data = . ;
6894 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6895 end_of_data = . ;
6896 @}
6897 @end smallexample
6898
6899 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6900 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6901 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6902 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6903 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6904 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6905 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6906 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6907 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6908 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6909 as follows:
6910
6911 @smallexample
6912 SECTIONS
6913 @{
6914 start_of_text = . ;
6915 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6916 end_of_text = . ;
6917
6918 start_of_data = . ;
6919 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6920 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6921 end_of_data = . ;
6922 @}
6923 @end smallexample
6924
6925 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6926 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6927 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6928 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6929 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6930 section. So you could write:
6931
6932 @smallexample
6933 SECTIONS
6934 @{
6935 start_of_text = . ;
6936 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6937 end_of_text = . ;
6938
6939 . = . ;
6940 start_of_data = . ;
6941 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6942 end_of_data = . ;
6943 @}
6944 @end smallexample
6945
6946 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6947 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6948
6949 @need 2000
6950 @node Operators
6951 @subsection Operators
6952 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6953 @cindex arithmetic operators
6954 @cindex precedence in expressions
6955 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6956 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6957 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6958 @ifnottex
6959 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6960 @smallexample
6961 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6962 (highest)
6963 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6964 2 left * / %
6965 3 left + -
6966 4 left >> <<
6967 5 left > < <= >=
6968 6 left == !=
6969 7 left &
6970 8 left ^
6971 9 left |
6972 10 left &&
6973 11 left ||
6974 12 right ? :
6975 13 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
6976 (lowest)
6977 @end smallexample
6978 Notes:
6979 (1) Prefix operators
6980 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6981 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6982 @end ifnottex
6983 @tex
6984 \vskip \baselineskip
6985 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6986 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6987 \hrule
6988 \halign
6989 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6990 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6991 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6992 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6993 \noalign{\hrule}
6994 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6995 &highest&&&&&\cr
6996 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6997 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6998 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6999 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
7000 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
7001 &5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
7002 &6&&left&&== !=&\cr
7003 &7&&left&&\&&\cr
7004 &8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
7005 &9&&left&&|&\cr
7006 &10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
7007 &11&&left&&||&\cr
7008 &12&&right&&? :&\cr
7009 &13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
7010 &lowest&&&&&\cr
7011 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
7012 \hrule}
7013 @end tex
7014 @iftex
7015 {
7016 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
7017 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
7018 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
7019 }
7020 @end iftex
7021 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
7022
7023 @node Evaluation
7024 @subsection Evaluation
7025 @cindex lazy evaluation
7026 @cindex expression evaluation order
7027 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
7028 an expression when absolutely necessary.
7029
7030 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
7031 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
7032 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
7033 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
7034
7035 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
7036 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
7037 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
7038 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
7039
7040 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
7041 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
7042 allocation.
7043
7044 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
7045 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
7046
7047 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
7048 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
7049 following
7050 @smallexample
7051 @group
7052 SECTIONS
7053 @{
7054 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
7055 @{ *(.text) @}
7056 @}
7057 @end group
7058 @end smallexample
7059 @noindent
7060 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
7061 address}.
7062
7063 @node Expression Section
7064 @subsection The Section of an Expression
7065 @cindex expression sections
7066 @cindex absolute expressions
7067 @cindex relative expressions
7068 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
7069 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
7070 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7071 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
7072 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
7073 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
7074 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
7075 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
7076 operations.
7077
7078 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
7079 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
7080 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
7081 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
7082 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
7083 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
7084 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
7085 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
7086 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
7087 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
7088 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
7089 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
7090 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
7091 everywhere.
7092
7093 In the following simple example,
7094
7095 @smallexample
7096 @group
7097 SECTIONS
7098 @{
7099 . = 0x100;
7100 __executable_start = 0x100;
7101 .data :
7102 @{
7103 . = 0x10;
7104 __data_start = 0x10;
7105 *(.data)
7106 @}
7107 @dots{}
7108 @}
7109 @end group
7110 @end smallexample
7111
7112 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
7113 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
7114 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
7115 section in the second two assignments.
7116
7117 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
7118 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7119
7120 @itemize @bullet
7121 @item
7122 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
7123 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
7124 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
7125 @item
7126 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
7127 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
7128 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
7129 @item
7130 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
7131 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
7132 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
7133 before applying the operator.
7134 @end itemize
7135
7136 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
7137
7138 @itemize @bullet
7139 @item
7140 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7141 @item
7142 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7143 @item
7144 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
7145 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
7146 (after above conversions) is also a number when
7147 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7148 but an absolute address otherwise.
7149 @item
7150 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7151 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7152 section as the relative operand(s).
7153 @item
7154 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7155 conversions) is an absolute address.
7156 @end itemize
7157
7158 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7159 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7160 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7161 section @samp{.data}:
7162 @smallexample
7163 SECTIONS
7164 @{
7165 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7166 @}
7167 @end smallexample
7168 @noindent
7169 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7170 @samp{.data} section.
7171
7172 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7173 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7174
7175 @node Builtin Functions
7176 @subsection Builtin Functions
7177 @cindex functions in expressions
7178 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7179 use in linker script expressions.
7180
7181 @table @code
7182 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7183 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7184 @cindex expression, absolute
7185 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7186 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7187 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7188 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7189
7190 @item ADDR(@var{section})
7191 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7192 @cindex section address in expression
7193 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
7194 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7195 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7196 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7197 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7198 the other two will be absolute:
7199 @smallexample
7200 @group
7201 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7202 .output1 :
7203 @{
7204 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7205 @dots{}
7206 @}
7207 .output :
7208 @{
7209 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7210 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7211 @}
7212 @dots{} @}
7213 @end group
7214 @end smallexample
7215
7216 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
7217 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7218 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7219 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7220 @cindex round up location counter
7221 @cindex align location counter
7222 @cindex round up expression
7223 @cindex align expression
7224 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7225 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7226 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7227 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7228 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
7229 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
7230
7231 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7232 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7233 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7234 input sections:
7235 @smallexample
7236 @group
7237 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7238 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7239 *(.data)
7240 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7241 @}
7242 @dots{} @}
7243 @end group
7244 @end smallexample
7245 @noindent
7246 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7247 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7248 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7249 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7250
7251 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7252
7253 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7254 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7255 @cindex section alignment
7256 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7257 been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7258 section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7259 error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7260 return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7261 linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7262 example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7263 first value in that section.
7264 @smallexample
7265 @group
7266 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7267 .output @{
7268 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7269 @dots{}
7270 @}
7271 @dots{} @}
7272 @end group
7273 @end smallexample
7274
7275 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7276 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7277 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7278 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7279 section.
7280
7281 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7282 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7283 This is equivalent to either
7284 @smallexample
7285 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7286 @end smallexample
7287 or
7288 @smallexample
7289 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7290 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
7291 @end smallexample
7292 @noindent
7293 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7294 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7295 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7296 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7297 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7298 bytes in the on-disk file.
7299
7300 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7301 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7302 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
7303 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7304 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7305 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7306 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
7307
7308 @noindent
7309 Example:
7310 @smallexample
7311 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7312 @end smallexample
7313
7314 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7315 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7316 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7317 evaluation purposes.
7318
7319 @smallexample
7320 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7321 @end smallexample
7322
7323 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7324 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7325 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7326 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7327 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7328 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7329 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7330 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7331 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7332 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7333 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7334 section alignment.
7335
7336 @smallexample
7337 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7338 @end smallexample
7339
7340 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7341 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7342 @cindex symbol defaults
7343 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7344 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7345 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7346 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7347 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7348 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7349 existed, its value is preserved:
7350
7351 @smallexample
7352 @group
7353 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7354 .text : @{
7355 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7356 @dots{}
7357 @}
7358 @dots{}
7359 @}
7360 @end group
7361 @end smallexample
7362
7363 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7364 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7365 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7366
7367 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7368 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7369 @cindex section load address in expression
7370 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7371 Section LMA}).
7372
7373 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7374 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7375 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7376 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7377
7378 @kindex MAX
7379 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7380 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7381
7382 @kindex MIN
7383 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7384 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7385
7386 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7387 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7388 @cindex unallocated address, next
7389 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7390 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7391 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7392 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7393
7394 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7395 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7396 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7397
7398 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7399 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7400 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7401 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7402 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7403 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7404 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7405 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7406 name.
7407
7408 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7409 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7410 @cindex section size
7411 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7412 been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7413 section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7414 error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7415 return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7416 linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7417 example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7418 values:
7419 @smallexample
7420 @group
7421 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7422 .output @{
7423 .start = . ;
7424 @dots{}
7425 .end = . ;
7426 @}
7427 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7428 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7429 @dots{} @}
7430 @end group
7431 @end smallexample
7432
7433 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7434 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7435 @cindex header size
7436 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7437 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7438 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7439 choose, to facilitate paging.
7440
7441 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7442 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7443 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7444 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7445 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7446 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7447 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7448 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7449 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7450 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7451 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7452 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7453 @end table
7454
7455 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7456 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7457 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7458 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7459 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7460 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7461 linker will report an error.
7462
7463 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7464
7465 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7466 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7467 commands.
7468
7469 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7470 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7471 read. This can affect archive searching.
7472
7473 @node Plugins
7474 @chapter Linker Plugins
7475
7476 @cindex plugins
7477 @cindex linker plugins
7478 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7479 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7480 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7481
7482 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7483 be added here later.
7484
7485 Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
7486 command line option. @xref{Options}.
7487
7488 @menu
7489 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7490 @end menu
7491
7492 @node libdep Plugin
7493 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7494 @cindex static library dependencies
7495 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7496 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7497 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7498 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7499 rose to ascendance.
7500
7501 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7502 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7503 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7504 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7505 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7506 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7507 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7508 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7509
7510 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7511 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7512 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7513 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7514 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7515 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7516 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7517 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7518 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7519
7520 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7521 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7522 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7523
7524 @smallexample
7525 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7526 @end smallexample
7527
7528 @ifset GENERIC
7529 @node Machine Dependent
7530 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7531
7532 @cindex machine dependencies
7533 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7534 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7535 functionality are not listed.
7536
7537 @menu
7538 @ifset H8300
7539 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7540 @end ifset
7541 @ifset M68HC11
7542 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7543 @end ifset
7544 @ifset ARM
7545 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7546 @end ifset
7547 @ifset HPPA
7548 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7549 @end ifset
7550 @ifset M68K
7551 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7552 @end ifset
7553 @ifset MIPS
7554 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7555 @end ifset
7556 @ifset MMIX
7557 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7558 @end ifset
7559 @ifset MSP430
7560 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7561 @end ifset
7562 @ifset NDS32
7563 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7564 @end ifset
7565 @ifset NIOSII
7566 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7567 @end ifset
7568 @ifset POWERPC
7569 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7570 @end ifset
7571 @ifset POWERPC64
7572 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7573 @end ifset
7574 @ifset S/390
7575 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7576 @end ifset
7577 @ifset SPU
7578 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7579 @end ifset
7580 @ifset TICOFF
7581 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7582 @end ifset
7583 @ifset WIN32
7584 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7585 @end ifset
7586 @ifset XTENSA
7587 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7588 @end ifset
7589 @end menu
7590 @end ifset
7591
7592 @ifset H8300
7593 @ifclear GENERIC
7594 @raisesections
7595 @end ifclear
7596
7597 @node H8/300
7598 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7599
7600 @cindex H8/300 support
7601 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7602 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7603
7604 @table @emph
7605 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7606 @item relaxing address modes
7607 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7608 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7609 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7610 respectively.
7611
7612 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7613 @item synthesizing instructions
7614 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7615 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7616 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7617 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7618 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7619 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7620 top page of memory).
7621
7622 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7623 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7624 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7625 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7626 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7627 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7628 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7629
7630 @item bit manipulation instructions
7631 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7632 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7633 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7634 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7635 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7636 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7637 the top page of memory).
7638
7639 @item system control instructions
7640 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7641 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7642 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7643 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7644 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7645 the top page of memory).
7646 @end table
7647
7648 @ifclear GENERIC
7649 @lowersections
7650 @end ifclear
7651 @end ifset
7652
7653 @ifclear GENERIC
7654 @ifset Renesas
7655 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7656 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7657 @node Renesas
7658 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7659
7660 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7661 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7662 options are required for these chips.
7663 @end ifset
7664 @end ifclear
7665
7666 @ifset ARM
7667 @ifclear GENERIC
7668 @raisesections
7669 @end ifclear
7670
7671 @ifset M68HC11
7672 @ifclear GENERIC
7673 @raisesections
7674 @end ifclear
7675
7676 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7677 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7678
7679 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7680
7681 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7682
7683 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7684 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7685
7686 @table @emph
7687 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7688 @item relaxing address modes
7689 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7690 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7691 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7692 respectively.
7693
7694 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7695 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7696 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7697
7698 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7699 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7700 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7701 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7702 @code{bset} instructions.
7703
7704 @end table
7705
7706 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7707
7708 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7709 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7710 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7711 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7712 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7713 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7714 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7715 point to the function trampoline.
7716
7717 @ifclear GENERIC
7718 @lowersections
7719 @end ifclear
7720 @end ifset
7721
7722 @node ARM
7723 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7724
7725 @cindex ARM interworking support
7726 @kindex --support-old-code
7727 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7728 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7729 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7730 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7731 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7732 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7733 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7734 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7735 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7736 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7737
7738 @cindex thumb entry point
7739 @cindex entry point, thumb
7740 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7741 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7742 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7743 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7744 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7745 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7746
7747 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7748 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7749 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7750 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7751 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7752 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7753
7754 @cindex BE8
7755 @kindex --be8
7756 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7757 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7758 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7759 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7760 little-endian code.
7761
7762 @cindex TARGET1
7763 @kindex --target1-rel
7764 @kindex --target1-abs
7765 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7766 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7767 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7768 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7769
7770 @cindex TARGET2
7771 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7772 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7773 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7774 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7775 @table @samp
7776 @item rel
7777 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7778 @item abs
7779 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7780 @item got-rel
7781 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7782 @end table
7783
7784 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7785 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7786 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7787 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7788 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7789 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7790
7791 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7792 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7793 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7794
7795 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7796 relocations are ignored.
7797
7798 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7799 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7800 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7801 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7802
7803 @smallexample
7804 TST rM, #1
7805 MOVEQ PC, rM
7806 BX Rn
7807 @end smallexample
7808
7809 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7810 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7811 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7812
7813 @cindex USE_BLX
7814 @kindex --use-blx
7815 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7816 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7817 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7818 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7819 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7820
7821 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7822 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7823 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7824 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7825 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7826 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7827 the support code can read the intended values.
7828
7829 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7830 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7831 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7832 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7833 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7834 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7835
7836 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7837 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7838 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7839 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7840 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7841 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7842
7843 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7844 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7845 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7846 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7847 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7848 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7849 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7850
7851 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7852 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7853 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7854 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7855 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7856 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7857 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7858
7859 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7860 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7861 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7862
7863 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7864 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7865
7866 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7867 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7868 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7869 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7870 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7871 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7872 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7873 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7874
7875 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7876 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7877
7878 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7879 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7880 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7881 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7882 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7883
7884 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7885 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7886 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7887 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7888 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7889 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7890
7891 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7892 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7893
7894 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7895 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7896 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7897 occurs.
7898
7899 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7900 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7901 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7902 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7903 occurs.
7904
7905 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7906 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7907 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7908 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7909 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7910 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7911 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7912 not be diagnosed.
7913
7914 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7915 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7916 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7917 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7918 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7919 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7920 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7921
7922 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7923 @kindex --pic-veneer
7924 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7925 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7926 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7927 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7928
7929 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7930 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7931 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7932 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7933 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7934 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7935 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7936 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7937 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7938 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7939 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7940 where they should be placed.
7941
7942 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7943 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7944 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7945 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7946 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7947 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7948 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7949 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7950 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7951 from the input sections.
7952
7953 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7954 @samp{N = +1}.
7955
7956 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7957 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7958 otherwise.
7959
7960 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7961 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7962 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7963 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7964
7965 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7966
7967 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7968 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7969 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7970 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7971
7972 Please contact ARM for further details.
7973
7974 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7975 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7976 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7977 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7978
7979 @kindex --long-plt
7980 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7981 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7982 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7983 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7984
7985 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7986 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7987 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7988 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7989
7990 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7991 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7992 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7993 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7994 veneers in memory.
7995
7996 @kindex --cmse-implib
7997 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7998 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7999 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
8000 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
8001 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
8002
8003 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
8004 @cindex Input import library
8005 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
8006 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
8007 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
8008 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
8009 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
8010 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
8011 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
8012 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
8013 specified.
8014
8015 @ifclear GENERIC
8016 @lowersections
8017 @end ifclear
8018 @end ifset
8019
8020 @ifset HPPA
8021 @ifclear GENERIC
8022 @raisesections
8023 @end ifclear
8024
8025 @node HPPA ELF32
8026 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
8027 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
8028 @kindex --multi-subspace
8029 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
8030 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
8031 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
8032 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
8033 multiple sub-spaces.
8034
8035 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
8036 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
8037 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
8038 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8039 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8040 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8041 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8042 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8043 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8044 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8045 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8046 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8047 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8048 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8049 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8050 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8051
8052 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8053 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8054 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8055 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8056
8057 @ifclear GENERIC
8058 @lowersections
8059 @end ifclear
8060 @end ifset
8061
8062 @ifset M68K
8063 @ifclear GENERIC
8064 @raisesections
8065 @end ifclear
8066
8067 @node M68K
8068 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
8069
8070 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
8071 @kindex --got=@var{type}
8072 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
8073 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
8074 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
8075 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
8076 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
8077 entries only at non-negative offsets.
8078 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
8079 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
8080 support such GOTs.
8081 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
8082 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
8083 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
8084 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
8085
8086 @ifclear GENERIC
8087 @lowersections
8088 @end ifclear
8089 @end ifset
8090
8091 @ifset MIPS
8092 @ifclear GENERIC
8093 @raisesections
8094 @end ifclear
8095
8096 @node MIPS
8097 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
8098
8099 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
8100 @kindex --insn32
8101 @kindex --no-insn32
8102 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
8103 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
8104 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
8105 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
8106 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
8107 including 16-bit ones where possible.
8108
8109 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
8110 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
8111 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
8112 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
8113 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
8114 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
8115 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
8116 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
8117 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
8118 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
8119 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
8120 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
8121
8122 @ifclear GENERIC
8123 @lowersections
8124 @end ifclear
8125 @end ifset
8126
8127 @ifset MMIX
8128 @ifclear GENERIC
8129 @raisesections
8130 @end ifclear
8131
8132 @node MMIX
8133 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
8134 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
8135 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
8136 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
8137 can translate between the two formats.
8138
8139 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8140 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8141 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8142 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8143 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8144 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8145 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8146 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8147
8148 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8149 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8150 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8151 of a section.
8152
8153 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8154 are left out from an mmo file.
8155
8156 @ifclear GENERIC
8157 @lowersections
8158 @end ifclear
8159 @end ifset
8160
8161 @ifset MSP430
8162 @ifclear GENERIC
8163 @raisesections
8164 @end ifclear
8165
8166 @node MSP430
8167 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
8168 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8169 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8170 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8171
8172 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
8173 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8174
8175 @table @code
8176 @item @samp{.vectors}
8177 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8178
8179 @item @samp{.bootloader}
8180 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8181 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8182
8183 @item @samp{.infomem}
8184 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8185 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8186
8187 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
8188 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8189 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8190
8191 @item @samp{.noinit}
8192 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8193
8194 The last two sections are used by gcc.
8195 @end table
8196
8197 @table @option
8198 @cindex MSP430 Options
8199 @kindex --code-region
8200 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8201 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8202 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8203 using this option.
8204
8205 @kindex --data-region
8206 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8207 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8208 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8209 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8210
8211 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8212 @item --disable-sec-transformation
8213 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8214 and @code{--data-region} options.
8215 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8216 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8217 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8218 @end table
8219
8220 @ifclear GENERIC
8221 @lowersections
8222 @end ifclear
8223 @end ifset
8224
8225 @ifset NDS32
8226 @ifclear GENERIC
8227 @raisesections
8228 @end ifclear
8229
8230 @node NDS32
8231 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
8232 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
8233 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8234 relaxes objects according to these options.
8235
8236 @table @code
8237 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8238 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8239
8240 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8241 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8242
8243 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8244 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8245
8246 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8247 Export the EX9 table after linking.
8248
8249 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8250 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8251
8252 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8253 Update the existing EX9 table.
8254
8255 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8256 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8257
8258 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8259 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8260
8261 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8262 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8263
8264 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8265 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8266 @end table
8267
8268 @ifclear GENERIC
8269 @lowersections
8270 @end ifclear
8271 @end ifset
8272
8273 @ifset NIOSII
8274 @ifclear GENERIC
8275 @raisesections
8276 @end ifclear
8277
8278 @node Nios II
8279 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8280 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
8281 @kindex --relax on Nios II
8282
8283 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8284 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8285 which may result in @command{ld} giving
8286 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8287 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8288 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8289 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8290 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8291 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8292 larger than 256MB.
8293
8294 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8295 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8296 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8297 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8298 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8299 register as a temporary.
8300
8301 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8302 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8303 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8304
8305 @ifclear GENERIC
8306 @lowersections
8307 @end ifclear
8308 @end ifset
8309
8310 @ifset POWERPC
8311 @ifclear GENERIC
8312 @raisesections
8313 @end ifclear
8314
8315 @node PowerPC ELF32
8316 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8317 @cindex PowerPC long branches
8318 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
8319 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8320 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8321 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8322 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8323 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8324 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
8325 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8326 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8327 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8328 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
8329
8330 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8331 @table @option
8332 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8333 @kindex --bss-plt
8334 @item --bss-plt
8335 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8336 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8337 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8338 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8339 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8340 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8341 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8342 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8343
8344 @kindex --secure-plt
8345 @item --secure-plt
8346 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8347 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8348 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8349 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8350 style BSS PLT.
8351
8352 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8353 @kindex --sdata-got
8354 @item --sdata-got
8355 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8356 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8357 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8358 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8359 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8360 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8361 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8362 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8363 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8364 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8365 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8366 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8367
8368 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8369 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8370 @item --emit-stub-syms
8371 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8372 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8373
8374 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8375 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8376 @item --no-tls-optimize
8377 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8378 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8379 disable the optimization.
8380 @end table
8381
8382 @ifclear GENERIC
8383 @lowersections
8384 @end ifclear
8385 @end ifset
8386
8387 @ifset POWERPC64
8388 @ifclear GENERIC
8389 @raisesections
8390 @end ifclear
8391
8392 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8393 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8394
8395 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8396 @table @option
8397 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8398 @kindex --stub-group-size
8399 @item --stub-group-size
8400 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8401 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8402 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8403 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8404 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8405 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8406 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8407 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8408 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8409 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8410 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8411 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8412 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8413 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8414
8415 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8416 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8417 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8418 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8419
8420 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8421 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8422 @item --emit-stub-syms
8423 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8424 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8425
8426 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8427 @kindex --dotsyms
8428 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8429 @item --dotsyms
8430 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8431 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8432 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8433 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8434 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8435 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8436 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8437 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8438 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8439 feature.
8440
8441 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8442 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8443 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8444 @item --save-restore-funcs
8445 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8446 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8447 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8448 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8449 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8450 link.
8451
8452 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8453 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8454 @item --no-tls-optimize
8455 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8456 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8457 disable the optimization.
8458
8459 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8460 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8461 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8462 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8463 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8464 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8465 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8466 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8467 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8468 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8469 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8470 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8471 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8472 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8473 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8474 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8475 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8476 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8477 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8478 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8479 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8480 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8481 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8482 register saves.
8483
8484 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8485 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8486 @item --no-opd-optimize
8487 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8488 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8489 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8490 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8491
8492 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8493 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8494 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8495 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8496 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8497 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8498 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8499
8500 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8501 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8502 @item --no-toc-optimize
8503 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8504 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8505 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8506 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8507 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8508 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8509 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8510 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8511 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8512 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8513 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8514 optimization.
8515
8516 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8517 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8518 @item --no-inline-optimize
8519 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8520 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8521 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8522 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8523 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8524 disables that optimization.
8525
8526 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8527 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8528 @item --no-multi-toc
8529 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8530 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8531 where TOC
8532 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8533 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8534 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8535 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8536 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8537 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8538 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8539 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8540
8541 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8542 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8543 @item --no-toc-sort
8544 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8545 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8546 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8547 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8548 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8549 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8550 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8551 off this feature.
8552
8553 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8554 @kindex --plt-align
8555 @kindex --no-plt-align
8556 @item --plt-align
8557 @itemx --no-plt-align
8558 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8559 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8560 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8561 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8562 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8563 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8564 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8565
8566 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8567 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8568 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8569 @item --plt-static-chain
8570 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8571 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8572 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8573 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8574
8575 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8576 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8577 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8578 @item --plt-thread-safe
8579 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8580 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8581 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8582 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8583 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8584 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8585 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8586 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8587 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8588 default behaviour.
8589
8590 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8591 @kindex --plt-localentry
8592 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8593 @item --plt-localentry
8594 @itemx --no-localentry
8595 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8596 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8597 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8598 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8599 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8600 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8601 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8602 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8603 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8604 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8605 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8606 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8607
8608 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8609 @kindex --power10-stubs
8610 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8611 @item --power10-stubs
8612 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8613 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8614 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8615 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8616 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8617 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8618 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8619 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8620 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8621 auto mode.
8622 @end table
8623
8624 @ifclear GENERIC
8625 @lowersections
8626 @end ifclear
8627 @end ifset
8628
8629 @ifset S/390
8630 @ifclear GENERIC
8631 @raisesections
8632 @end ifclear
8633
8634 @node S/390 ELF
8635 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8636
8637 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8638 @table @option
8639
8640 @cindex S/390
8641 @kindex --s390-pgste
8642 @item --s390-pgste
8643 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8644 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8645 binaries marked that way.
8646 @end table
8647
8648 @ifclear GENERIC
8649 @lowersections
8650 @end ifclear
8651 @end ifset
8652
8653 @ifset SPU
8654 @ifclear GENERIC
8655 @raisesections
8656 @end ifclear
8657
8658 @node SPU ELF
8659 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8660
8661 @cindex SPU ELF options
8662 @table @option
8663
8664 @cindex SPU plugins
8665 @kindex --plugin
8666 @item --plugin
8667 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8668
8669 @cindex SPU overlays
8670 @kindex --no-overlays
8671 @item --no-overlays
8672 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8673 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8674 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8675 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8676
8677 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8678 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8679 @item --emit-stub-syms
8680 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8681 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8682
8683 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8684 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8685 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8686 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8687 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8688 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8689
8690 @cindex SPU local store size
8691 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8692 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8693 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8694 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8695 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8696
8697 @cindex SPU
8698 @kindex --stack-analysis
8699 @item --stack-analysis
8700 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8701 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8702 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8703 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8704 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8705 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8706 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8707 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8708 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8709 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8710 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8711 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8712 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8713 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8714 and calls will be given.
8715
8716 @cindex SPU
8717 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8718 @item --emit-stack-syms
8719 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8720 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8721 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8722 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8723 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8724 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8725 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8726 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8727 @end table
8728
8729 @ifclear GENERIC
8730 @lowersections
8731 @end ifclear
8732 @end ifset
8733
8734 @ifset TICOFF
8735 @ifclear GENERIC
8736 @raisesections
8737 @end ifclear
8738
8739 @node TI COFF
8740 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8741 @cindex TI COFF versions
8742 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8743 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8744 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8745 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8746 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8747 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8748
8749 @ifclear GENERIC
8750 @lowersections
8751 @end ifclear
8752 @end ifset
8753
8754 @ifset WIN32
8755 @ifclear GENERIC
8756 @raisesections
8757 @end ifclear
8758
8759 @node WIN32
8760 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8761
8762 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8763 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8764 command-line options mentioned here.
8765
8766 @table @emph
8767 @cindex import libraries
8768 @item import libraries
8769 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8770 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8771 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8772 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8773 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8774 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8775
8776 @item Resource only DLLs
8777 It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8778 @samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8779 must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
8780 will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
8781 there is no input to go into them.
8782
8783 The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8784 should be changed to match the desired format.
8785
8786 @example
8787 OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8788 SECTIONS
8789 @{
8790 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8791 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8792 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8793 @{
8794 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8795 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8796 @}
8797 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8798 @}
8799 @end example
8800
8801 With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8802 line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8803 @file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8804
8805 @smallexample
8806 ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8807 @end smallexample
8808
8809 @item exporting DLL symbols
8810 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8811 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8812
8813 @table @emph
8814 @item using auto-export functionality
8815 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8816 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8817 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8818
8819 @itemize
8820 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8821 @item --exclude-symbols
8822 @item --exclude-libs
8823 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8824 @item --version-script
8825 @end itemize
8826
8827 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8828 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8829 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8830 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8831 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8832 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8833 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8834 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8835
8836 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8837 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8838 if either of the following are true:
8839
8840 @itemize
8841 @item A DEF file is used.
8842 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8843 @end itemize
8844
8845 @item using a DEF file
8846 @cindex using a DEF file
8847 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8848 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8849 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8850 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8851 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8852
8853 @example
8854 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8855 @end example
8856
8857 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8858 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8859
8860 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8861
8862 @example
8863 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8864
8865 EXPORTS
8866 foo
8867 bar
8868 _bar = bar
8869 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8870 var1 DATA
8871 doo = foo == foo2
8872 eoo DATA == var1
8873 @end example
8874
8875 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8876 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8877 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8878 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8879 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8880 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8881 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8882 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8883 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8884
8885 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8886 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8887 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8888
8889 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8890 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8891 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8892 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8893
8894 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8895 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8896 non-default base address for the image.
8897
8898 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8899 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8900 filename specified on the command line.
8901
8902 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8903
8904 @example
8905 EXPORTS
8906 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8907 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8908 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8909 @end example
8910
8911 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8912 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8913 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8914 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8915 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8916 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8917 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8918
8919 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8920
8921 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8922 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8923 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8924 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8925 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8926
8927 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8928 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8929 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8930 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8931
8932 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8933 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8934 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8935 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8936 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8937 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8938 application will behave unexpectedly.
8939
8940 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8941 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8942 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8943 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8944 the DLL without an import library.
8945
8946 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8947 other DEF file statements
8948
8949 @cindex creating a DEF file
8950 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8951 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8952
8953 @item Using decorations
8954 @cindex Using decorations
8955 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8956 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8957 declared as:
8958
8959 @example
8960 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8961 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8962 @end example
8963
8964 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8965 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8966 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8967 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8968
8969 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8970 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8971 instead:
8972
8973 @example
8974 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8975 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8976 @end example
8977
8978 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8979 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8980 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8981 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8982 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8983 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8984 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8985 information.
8986 @end table
8987
8988 @cindex automatic data imports
8989 @item automatic data imports
8990 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8991 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8992 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8993 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8994 code to these platforms, especially for large
8995 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8996 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8997 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8998 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8999 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
9000 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
9001 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
9002 trigger the feature's use.
9003
9004 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
9005 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
9006
9007 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
9008 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
9009
9010 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
9011 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
9012 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
9013 below.
9014
9015 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
9016 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
9017 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
9018 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
9019 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
9020 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
9021 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
9022 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
9023 references.
9024
9025 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
9026 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
9027 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
9028 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
9029 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
9030 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
9031 run without error on an older system.
9032
9033 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
9034 enabled as needed.
9035
9036 @cindex direct linking to a dll
9037 @item direct linking to a dll
9038 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
9039 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
9040 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
9041 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
9042 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
9043 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
9044 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
9045 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
9046 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
9047 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
9048
9049 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
9050 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
9051 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
9052 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
9053 select the dll instead of an import library.
9054
9055
9056 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
9057 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
9058
9059 @example
9060 libxxx.dll.a
9061 xxx.dll.a
9062 libxxx.a
9063 xxx.lib
9064 libxxx.lib
9065 cygxxx.dll (*)
9066 libxxx.dll
9067 xxx.dll
9068 @end example
9069
9070 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
9071
9072 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
9073 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
9074 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
9075 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
9076 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
9077
9078 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
9079 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
9080 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
9081 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
9082 could coexist on the same machine.
9083
9084 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
9085 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
9086 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
9087
9088 @example
9089 bin/
9090 cygxxx.dll
9091 lib/
9092 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
9093 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
9094 @end example
9095
9096 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
9097 done two ways:
9098
9099 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
9100 @example
9101 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
9102 @end example
9103
9104 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
9105 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
9106 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
9107 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
9108
9109 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
9110 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
9111 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
9112 making the app/dll.
9113
9114 @example
9115 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
9116 @end example
9117
9118 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
9119
9120 @example
9121 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
9122 @end example
9123
9124 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
9125 perfectly legal
9126
9127 @example
9128 bin/
9129 cygxxx-5.dll
9130 lib/
9131 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
9132 @end example
9133
9134 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
9135 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
9136 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
9137
9138 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
9139 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
9140
9141 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9142 work with auto-imported data.
9143
9144 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9145 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9146 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9147 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9148 possible to do this without an import lib.
9149
9150 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9151 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9152 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9153 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9154
9155 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
9156 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9157 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9158 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
9159 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9160 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9161 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
9162
9163 @item symbol aliasing
9164 @table @emph
9165 @item adding additional names
9166 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
9167 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9168 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9169 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
9170 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
9171
9172 @example
9173 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9174
9175 EXPORTS
9176 foo
9177 _foo = foo
9178 @end example
9179
9180 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9181
9182 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9183 source code using the "weak" attribute:
9184
9185 @example
9186 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
9187 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
9188 @end example
9189
9190 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9191 symbols.
9192
9193 @item renaming symbols
9194 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
9195 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
9196 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9197 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
9198 created). In the following example:
9199
9200 @example
9201 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9202
9203 EXPORTS
9204 _foo = foo
9205 @end example
9206
9207 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9208 @samp{_foo}.
9209 @end table
9210
9211 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
9212 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
9213 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
9214 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9215 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9216 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9217 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9218 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9219 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9220 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
9221 which is probably not what you wanted.
9222
9223 @cindex weak externals
9224 @item weak externals
9225 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9226 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9227 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9228 are three variants of weak externals:
9229 @itemize
9230 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9231 called lazy externals.
9232 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9233 This form is not presently implemented.
9234 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9235 implemented.
9236 @end itemize
9237 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9238 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9239 uses a default value.
9240
9241 @cindex aligned common symbols
9242 @item aligned common symbols
9243 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9244 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9245 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9246 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9247 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9248 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9249 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9250 warnings about unknown linker directives.
9251
9252 @end table
9253
9254 @ifclear GENERIC
9255 @lowersections
9256 @end ifclear
9257 @end ifset
9258
9259 @ifset XTENSA
9260 @ifclear GENERIC
9261 @raisesections
9262 @end ifclear
9263
9264 @node Xtensa
9265 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9266
9267 @cindex Xtensa processors
9268 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9269 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9270 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9271 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9272 example, with the command:
9273
9274 @smallexample
9275 SECTIONS
9276 @{
9277 .text : @{
9278 *(.literal .text)
9279 @}
9280 @}
9281 @end smallexample
9282
9283 @noindent
9284 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9285 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9286 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9287 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9288 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9289 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9290 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
9291
9292 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
9293 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
9294 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9295 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9296 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9297 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9298 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9299 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9300 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9301 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9302 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9303 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9304
9305 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9306 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9307 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9308 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9309 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9310 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9311 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9312 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9313 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9314 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9315 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9316 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9317 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9318 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9319
9320 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9321 control the linker:
9322
9323 @cindex Xtensa options
9324 @table @option
9325 @item --size-opt
9326 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9327 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9328 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9329 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9330 preserve the correctness of the code.
9331
9332 @item --abi-windowed
9333 @itemx --abi-call0
9334 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9335 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9336 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9337 conventions.
9338 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9339 of the first input object.
9340 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9341 or the chosen output object ABI.
9342 @end table
9343
9344 @ifclear GENERIC
9345 @lowersections
9346 @end ifclear
9347 @end ifset
9348
9349 @ifclear SingleFormat
9350 @node BFD
9351 @chapter BFD
9352
9353 @cindex back end
9354 @cindex object file management
9355 @cindex object formats available
9356 @kindex objdump -i
9357 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9358 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9359 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9360 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9361 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9362 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9363 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9364 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9365 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9366
9367 @cindex BFD requirements
9368 @cindex requirements for BFD
9369 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9370 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9371 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9372 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9373 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9374 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9375 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9376
9377 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9378 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9379 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9380 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9381
9382 @menu
9383 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9384 @end menu
9385
9386 @node BFD outline
9387 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9388 @cindex opening object files
9389 @include bfdsumm.texi
9390 @end ifclear
9391
9392 @node Reporting Bugs
9393 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9394 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9395 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9396
9397 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9398
9399 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9400 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9401 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9402 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9403 @command{ld}.
9404
9405 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9406 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9407
9408 @menu
9409 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9410 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9411 @end menu
9412
9413 @node Bug Criteria
9414 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9415 @cindex bug criteria
9416
9417 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9418
9419 @itemize @bullet
9420 @cindex fatal signal
9421 @cindex linker crash
9422 @cindex crash of linker
9423 @item
9424 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9425 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9426
9427 @cindex error on valid input
9428 @item
9429 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9430
9431 @cindex invalid input
9432 @item
9433 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9434 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9435 object files are correct.
9436
9437 @item
9438 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9439 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9440 @end itemize
9441
9442 @node Bug Reporting
9443 @section How to Report Bugs
9444 @cindex bug reports
9445 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9446
9447 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9448 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9449 recommend you contact that organization first.
9450
9451 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9452 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9453 distribution.
9454
9455 @ifset BUGURL
9456 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9457 @value{BUGURL}.
9458 @end ifset
9459
9460 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9461 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9462 fact or leave it out, state it!
9463
9464 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9465 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9466 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9467 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9468 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9469 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9470 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9471 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9472 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9473 and the most helpful.
9474
9475 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9476 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9477 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9478
9479 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9480 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9481 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9482 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9483
9484 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9485
9486 @itemize @bullet
9487 @item
9488 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9489 the @samp{--version} argument.
9490
9491 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9492 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9493
9494 @item
9495 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9496 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9497
9498 @item
9499 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9500 version number.
9501
9502 @item
9503 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9504 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9505
9506 @item
9507 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9508 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9509 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9510 sufficient.
9511
9512 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9513 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9514
9515 @item
9516 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9517 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9518 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9519 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9520 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9521 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9522 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9523 attachments are best.
9524
9525 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9526 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9527 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9528 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9529 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9530
9531 @item
9532 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9533 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9534
9535 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9536 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9537 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9538 a chance to make a mistake.
9539
9540 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9541 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9542 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9543 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9544 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9545 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9546 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9547 any conclusion from our observations.
9548
9549 @item
9550 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9551 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9552 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9553 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9554 context, not by line number.
9555
9556 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9557 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9558 @end itemize
9559
9560 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9561
9562 @itemize @bullet
9563 @item
9564 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9565
9566 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9567 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9568 changes will not affect it.
9569
9570 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9571 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9572 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9573 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9574
9575 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9576 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9577 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9578 less time, and so on.
9579
9580 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9581 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9582
9583 @item
9584 A patch for the bug.
9585
9586 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9587 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9588 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9589 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9590
9591 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9592 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9593 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9594 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9595 fixed.
9596
9597 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9598 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9599 help us to understand.
9600
9601 @item
9602 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9603
9604 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9605 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9606 @end itemize
9607
9608 @node MRI
9609 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9610 @cindex MRI compatibility
9611 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9612 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9613 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9614 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9615 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9616 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9617 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9618
9619 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9620 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9621 features to make use of them.
9622
9623 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9624 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9625
9626 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9627 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9628 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9629 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9630 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9631
9632 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9633
9634 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9635 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9636 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9637
9638 @table @code
9639 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9640 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9641 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9642 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9643 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9644 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9645 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9646 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9647 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9648 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9649 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9650
9651 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9652 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9653 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9654 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9655
9656 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9657
9658 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9659 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9660 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9661 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9662
9663 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9664 @item BASE @var{expression}
9665 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9666 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9667
9668 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9669 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9670 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9671 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9672
9673 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9674 @item END
9675 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9676
9677 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9678 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9679 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9680 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9681
9682 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9683 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9684 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9685 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9686
9687 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9688 same line, with no change in its effect.
9689
9690 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9691 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9692 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9693 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9694 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9695 command line.
9696
9697 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9698 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9699 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9700 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9701 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9702
9703 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9704 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9705 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9706 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9707 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9708 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9709 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9710 file, in the order specified.
9711
9712 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9713 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9714 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9715 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9716 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9717 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9718
9719 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9720 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9721 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9722 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9723 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9724 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9725 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9726 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9727 @end table
9728
9729 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9730 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9731 @include fdl.texi
9732
9733 @node LD Index
9734 @unnumbered LD Index
9735
9736 @printindex cp
9737
9738 @tex
9739 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9740 % meantime:
9741 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9742 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9743 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9744 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9745 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9746 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9747 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9748 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9749 \page\colophon
9750 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9751 @end tex
9752
9753 @bye